blob: c07961a258d40773b380182e2b6bac7dc34e616f [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau6e893b92019-03-26 05:40:51 +01007 2019/03/26
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001109.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200111
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011210. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011310.1. Limitation
11410.2. Setup
11510.2.1. Cache section
11610.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117
1181. Quick reminder about HTTP
119----------------------------
120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100121When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
123on almost anything found in the contents.
124
125However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
126formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
127correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
128
129
1301.1. The HTTP transaction model
131-------------------------------
132
133The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100134to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
136connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137will involve a new connection :
138
139 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
140
141In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
142establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
143by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
144length.
145
146Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
147to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
148however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
149response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
150header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
151
152 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
153
154Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
155power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
156but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200157a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100159Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
161second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
162page :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
167latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
168correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
169the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100170server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
173time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
174are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
175parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
176carry the stream identifier.
177
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100178By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
179connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
180leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
182processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
183waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200185HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100186 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
187 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100188 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200190 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
371 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
480which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
481
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
4832.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200484----------------
485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100486Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100487values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
488otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
489numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
490for every keyword. Supported units are :
491
492 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
493 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
494 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
495 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
496 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
497 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
498
499
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005002.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200501-------------
502
503 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
504 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
505 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
506 global
507 daemon
508 maxconn 256
509
510 defaults
511 mode http
512 timeout connect 5000ms
513 timeout client 50000ms
514 timeout server 50000ms
515
516 frontend http-in
517 bind *:80
518 default_backend servers
519
520 backend servers
521 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
522
523
524 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
525 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
526 global
527 daemon
528 maxconn 256
529
530 defaults
531 mode http
532 timeout connect 5000ms
533 timeout client 50000ms
534 timeout server 50000ms
535
536 listen http-in
537 bind *:80
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
542
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100543 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200544
545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547--------------------
548
549Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
550are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
551of them have command-line equivalents.
552
553The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
554
555 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200556 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200558 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200559 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200561 - description
562 - deviceatlas-json-file
563 - deviceatlas-log-level
564 - deviceatlas-separator
565 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900566 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - gid
568 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100569 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100572 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200575 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100578 - presetenv
579 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580 - uid
581 - ulimit-n
582 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200583 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100584 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200585 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200587 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200588 - ssl-default-bind-options
589 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200590 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - ssl-default-server-options
592 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100593 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100594 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100595 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100596 - 51degrees-data-file
597 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200598 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200599 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100600
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200601 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200602 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200603 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200604 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100605 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100606 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100607 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200608 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200609 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200610 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200611 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612 - noepoll
613 - nokqueue
614 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100615 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300616 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000617 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100618 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200619 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200620 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200621 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000622 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000623 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200624 - tune.buffers.limit
625 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200626 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200627 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100628 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200629 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200630 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200631 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100632 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200633 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200634 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100635 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100636 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100637 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100638 - tune.lua.session-timeout
639 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200640 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100641 - tune.maxaccept
642 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200643 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200644 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200645 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100646 - tune.rcvbuf.client
647 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100648 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200649 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100650 - tune.sndbuf.client
651 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100652 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100653 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200654 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100655 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200656 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200657 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100658 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200659 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100660 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200661 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
662 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
663 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100664 - tune.zlib.memlevel
665 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100666
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200667 * Debugging
668 - debug
669 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200670
671
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006723.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200673------------------------------------
674
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200675ca-base <dir>
676 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200677 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
678 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200679
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200680chroot <jail dir>
681 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
682 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
683 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
684 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
685 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100686 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100687
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100688cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
689 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
690 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
691 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
692 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
693 set. These sets have the format
694
695 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
696
697 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100698 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100699 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
700 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100701 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
702 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100703 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100704 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100705 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100706 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100707 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
708 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
709 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
710 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100711
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100712 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
713 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
714 on the machine's word size.
715
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100716 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100717 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
718 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
719 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
720 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
721 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
722 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100723
724 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100725 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
726
727 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
728 # first 4 CPUs
729
730 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
731 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
732 # word size.
733
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100734 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100735 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100736 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
737 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
738 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
739
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
741 # and so on.
742 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
743 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
744 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
745
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100746 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100747 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
748 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
749 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
750
751 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
752 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
753 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
754
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100755 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
756 # and a thread range.
757 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
758 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
759 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
760
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200761crt-base <dir>
762 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
763 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
764 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
765
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200766daemon
767 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
768 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100769 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
770 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200771
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200772deviceatlas-json-file <path>
773 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100774 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200775
776deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100777 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200778 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
779
780deviceatlas-separator <char>
781 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
782 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
783
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100784deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200785 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
786 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
787 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100788
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900789external-check
790 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
791 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
792 See "option external-check".
793
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200794gid <number>
795 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
796 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
797 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100798 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
799 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200800 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100801
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100802hard-stop-after <time>
803 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
804
805 Arguments :
806 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
807 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
808 SIGUSR1 signal.
809
810 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
811 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
812 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
813
814 Example:
815 global
816 hard-stop-after 30s
817
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200818group <group name>
819 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
820 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100821
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200822log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100823 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100824 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100825 configured with "log global".
826
827 <address> can be one of:
828
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100829 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100830 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
831 port).
832
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100833 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
834 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
835 port).
836
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100837 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100838 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
839 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100840 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100841
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100842 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
843 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
844 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
845 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
846 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
847 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
848 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
849 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
850 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
851 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
852 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
853 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
854 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
855 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100856 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
857 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100858
859 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
860 "fd@2", see above.
861
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200862 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
863 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100864
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200865 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
866 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
867 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
868 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
869 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
870 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
871 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
872 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
873 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
874 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100875 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
876 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200877
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200878 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
879 one of the following :
880
881 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
882 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
883
884 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
885 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
886
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100887 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
888 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
889 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
890 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
891 logger consumes.
892
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100893 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
894 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
895 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
896 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
897
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100898 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200899
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100900 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
901 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
902 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
903
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100904 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
905 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
906 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
907 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200908
909 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200910 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
911 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
912 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
913 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
914 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
915 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200916
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200917 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200918
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100919log-send-hostname [<string>]
920 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
921 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
922 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
923 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
924 the logs.
925
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000926log-tag <string>
927 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
928 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
929 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100930 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000931
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100932lua-load <file>
933 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
934 used multiple times.
935
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100936master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200937 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
938 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
939 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100940 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200941 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
942 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100943 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
944 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
945 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
946 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
947 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200948
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100949 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200950
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200951nbproc <number>
952 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
953 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
954 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100955 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
956 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +0100957 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
958 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200959
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200960nbthread <number>
961 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +0100962 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
963 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
964 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
965 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
966 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100967 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
968 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
969 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
970 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
971 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
972 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
973 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200974
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200975pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100976 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200977 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
978 starting the process. See also "daemon".
979
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100980presetenv <name> <value>
981 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
982 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
983 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
984 and "unsetenv".
985
986resetenv [<name> ...]
987 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
988 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
989 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
990 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
991 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
992 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
993 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
994 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
995
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100996stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200997 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
998 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
999 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1000 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1001 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1002 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001003 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001004 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1005 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1006 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1007 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001008
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001009server-state-base <directory>
1010 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001011 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1012 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001013
1014server-state-file <file>
1015 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1016 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1017 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1018 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1019 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1020 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1021 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1022 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001023 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1024 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001025
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001026setenv <name> <value>
1027 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1028 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1029 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1030 and "unsetenv".
1031
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001032set-dumpable
1033 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1034 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1035 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1036 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1037 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1038 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1039 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1040 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1041 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1042 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1043 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1044 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1045 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1046 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1047 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1048 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1049 expected when dying.
1050
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001051ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1052 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1053 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001054 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001055 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001056 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1057 information and recommendations see e.g.
1058 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1059 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1060 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1061 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001062
1063ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1064 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1065 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1066 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1067 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1068 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001069 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1070 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1071 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001072 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001073
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001074ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1075 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1076 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1077 keyword to see available options.
1078
1079 Example:
1080 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001081 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001082
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001083ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1084 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1085 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001086 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001087 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001088 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1089 information and recommendations see e.g.
1090 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1091 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1092 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1093 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1094 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001095
1096ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1097 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1098 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1099 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1100 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1101 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001102 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1103 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1104 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1105 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001106
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001107ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1108 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1109 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1110 keyword to see available options.
1111
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001112ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1113 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1114 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1115 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001116 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001117 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001118 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1119 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1120 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1121 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001122 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1123 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1124 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1125
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001126ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1127 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1128 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1129 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1130
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001131stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1132 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1133 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1134 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001135 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001136 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001137
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001138 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1139 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1140 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001141
1142stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1143 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1144 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001145 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001146
1147stats maxconn <connections>
1148 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1149 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1150
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001151uid <number>
1152 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1153 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1154 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1155 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1156
1157ulimit-n <number>
1158 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1159 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1160 option.
1161
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001162unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1163 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1164
1165 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1166 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1167 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1168 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1169 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1170 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1171 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1172 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1173 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1174 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1175
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001176unsetenv [<name> ...]
1177 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1178 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1179 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1180 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1181 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1182 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1183 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1184
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001185user <user name>
1186 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1187 See also "uid" and "group".
1188
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001189node <name>
1190 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1191
1192 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1193 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1194 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1195 traffic.
1196
1197description <text>
1198 Add a text that describes the instance.
1199
1200 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1201 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1202 "<" and ">" characters.
1203
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100120451degrees-data-file <file path>
1205 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001206 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001207
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001208 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001209 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1210
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000121151degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001212 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1213 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1214 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1215
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001216 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001217 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1218
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200121951degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001220 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1221 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1222
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001223 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1224 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1225
122651degrees-cache-size <number>
1227 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1228 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1229 By default, this cache is disabled.
1230
1231 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001232 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1233
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001234
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012353.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001236-----------------------
1237
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001238busy-polling
1239 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1240 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1241 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1242 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1243 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1244 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1245 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1246 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1247 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1248 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1249 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1250 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1251 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1252 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1253 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1254 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1255 "poll" pollers.
1256
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001257max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1258 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1259 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1260 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1261 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1262 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1263 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1264 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1265 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1266
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001267maxconn <number>
1268 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1269 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1270 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001271 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1272 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1273 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1274 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001275 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1276 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1277 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1278 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1279 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1280 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001281
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001282maxconnrate <number>
1283 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1284 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1285 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1286 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1287 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1288 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1289 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1290 fairness.
1291
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001292maxcomprate <number>
1293 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001294 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001295 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1296 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1297 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001298 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001299 default value.
1300
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001301maxcompcpuusage <number>
1302 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1303 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1304 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1305 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1306 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1307 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1308 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1309 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1310
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001311maxpipes <number>
1312 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1313 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1314 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1315 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1316 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1317 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1318
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001319maxsessrate <number>
1320 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1321 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1322 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1323 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1324 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1325 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1326 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1327 fairness.
1328
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001329maxsslconn <number>
1330 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1331 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1332 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1333 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1334 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1335 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1336 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001337 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1338 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1339 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1340 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1341 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1342 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1343 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001344
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001345maxsslrate <number>
1346 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1347 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1348 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1349 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1350 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1351 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1352 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1353 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1354 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1355 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1356
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001357maxzlibmem <number>
1358 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1359 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1360 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001361 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1362 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1363 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1364
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001365noepoll
1366 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1367 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001368 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001369
1370nokqueue
1371 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1372 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1373 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1374
1375nopoll
1376 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1377 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001378 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001379 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001380
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001381nosplice
1382 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001383 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001384 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001385 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001386 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1387 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1388 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1389 "option splice-response".
1390
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001391nogetaddrinfo
1392 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1393 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1394
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001395noreuseport
1396 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1397 command line argument "-dR".
1398
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001399profiling.tasks { on | off }
1400 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. CPU profiling per
1401 task can be very convenient to report where the time is spent and which
1402 requests have what effect on which other request. It is not enabled by
1403 default as it may consume a little bit extra CPU. This requires a system
1404 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1405 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1406 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1407 CLI.
1408
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001409spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001410 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1411 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1412 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1413 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1414 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1415 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001416
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001417ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001418 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001419 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001420 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1421 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1422 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1423 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1424 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001425 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1426 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001427 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1428 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1429 openssl configuration file uses:
1430 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1431
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001432ssl-mode-async
1433 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001434 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001435 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1436 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1437 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1438 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1439 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001440
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001441tune.buffers.limit <number>
1442 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1443 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1444 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1445 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1446 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001447 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001448 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1449 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1450 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1451 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1452 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1453 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1454 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1455 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1456 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1457
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001458tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1459 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1460 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1461 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1462 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1463
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001464tune.bufsize <number>
1465 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1466 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1467 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1468 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1469 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1470 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1471 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001472 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1473 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1474 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001475 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001476 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1477 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1478 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001479
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001480tune.chksize <number>
1481 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1482 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1483 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1484 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1485 checks whenever possible.
1486
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001487tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1488 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1489 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1490 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1491 this value. The default value is 1.
1492
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001493tune.fail-alloc
1494 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1495 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1496 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1497 gracefully.
1498
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001499tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1500 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1501 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1502 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1503 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1504 change it.
1505
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001506tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1507 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001508 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1509 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001510 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1511 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1512 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1513 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1514 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1515
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001516tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1517 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1518 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1519 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1520 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1521 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1522 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1523 recommended not to change this value.
1524
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001525tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1526 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1527 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1528 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1529 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1530 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1531 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1532 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1533
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001534tune.http.cookielen <number>
1535 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1536 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1537 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1538 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1539 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1540 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1541 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1542 to change this value.
1543
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001544tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001545 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1546 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001547 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001548 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001549 configuration directives too.
1550 The default value is 1024.
1551
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001552tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1553 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1554 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1555 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1556 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1557 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1558 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001559 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1560 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1561 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001562
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001563tune.idletimer <timeout>
1564 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1565 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1566 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1567 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1568 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1569 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001570 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001571 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1572 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1573
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001574tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1575 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1576 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1577 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1578 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1579 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1580 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1581 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1582 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1583 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1584
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001585tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1586 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001587 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001588 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1589 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001590 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001591 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1592 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1593
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001594tune.lua.maxmem
1595 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1596 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1597 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1598 memory.
1599
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001600tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1601 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001602 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1603 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001604 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001605
1606tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1607 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1608 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1609 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1610 check servers.
1611
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001612tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1613 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1614 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1615 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001616 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001617
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001618tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001619 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1620 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1621 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1622 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1623 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1624 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1625 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1626 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1627 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1628 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001629
1630tune.maxpollevents <number>
1631 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1632 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1633 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1634 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1635 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1636
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001637tune.maxrewrite <number>
1638 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1639 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1640 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1641 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1642 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1643 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1644 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1645 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1646 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1647 bufsize.
1648
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001649tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1650 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1651 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1652 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1653 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1654 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1655 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1656 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1657 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1658 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1659 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1660 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1661 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1662 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1663 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1664 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1665 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1666 setting this parameter to 0.
1667
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001668tune.pipesize <number>
1669 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1670 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1671 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1672 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1673 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1674 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1675
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001676tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1677 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1678 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1679 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1680 default is 20.
1681
1682tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1683 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1684 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1685 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1686 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1687 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1688 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
1689 much sense in the general case when targetting connection reuse).
1690
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001691tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1692tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1693 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1694 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1695 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1696 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001697 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001698 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1699 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1700
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001701tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001702 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001703 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1704 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1705 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1706 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1707
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001708tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1709 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1710 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1711 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1712
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001713tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1714tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1715 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1716 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1717 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1718 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001719 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001720 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1721 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1722 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1723 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1724 notifying haproxy again.
1725
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001726tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001727 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1728 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1729 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001730 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001731 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001732 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001733 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1734 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1735 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001736 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1737 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001738
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001739tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001740 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001741 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1742 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1743 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1744 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1745 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1746
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001747tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1748 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001749 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001750 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1751 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1752 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1753 being used for too long.
1754
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001755tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1756 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1757 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1758 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1759 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1760 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1761 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1762 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1763 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1764 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1765 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001766 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001767 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001768
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001769tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1770 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1771 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1772 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1773 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1774 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1775 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1776 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001777 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1778 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001779
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001780tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1781 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1782 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1783 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1784 1000 entries.
1785
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001786tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1787 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1788 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1789 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1790
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001791tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001792tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001793tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1794tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1795tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001796 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1797 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1798 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1799 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1800 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1801 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1802 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1803 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001804
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001805 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1806 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1807 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1808 all available space is consumed.
1809 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1810 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1811 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001812
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001813tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1814 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001815 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001816 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001817 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001818 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1819
1820tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1821 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1822 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001823 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1824 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001825
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018263.3. Debugging
1827--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001828
1829debug
1830 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1831 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1832 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1833 system startup.
1834
1835quiet
1836 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1837 line argument "-q".
1838
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001839
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018403.4. Userlists
1841--------------
1842It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1843http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1844it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1845
1846userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001847 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001848 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1849
1850group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001851 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001852 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1853 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1854
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001855user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1856 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001857 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1858 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001859 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1860 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1861 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1862 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001863
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001864 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1865 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1866 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1867 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1868 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1869 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1870 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1871 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1872 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001873
1874 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001875 userlist L1
1876 group G1 users tiger,scott
1877 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001878
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001879 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1880 user scott insecure-password elgato
1881 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001882
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001883 userlist L2
1884 group G1
1885 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001886
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001887 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1888 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1889 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001890
1891 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001892
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001893
18943.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001895----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001896It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1897several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1898instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1899values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1900automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1901In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1902using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1903tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1904reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1905Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1906that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1907each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001908
1909peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001910 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001911 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1912
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001913bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1914 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
1915 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
1916
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001917disabled
1918 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1919 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1920 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1921
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001922default-bind [param*]
1923 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
1924
1925default-server [param*]
1926 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
1927
1928 Arguments:
1929 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1930 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1931 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1932 details.
1933
1934
1935 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
1936
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001937enable
1938 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1939
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001940peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001941 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1942 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1943 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1944 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1945 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1946 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1947
1948 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1949 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1950
1951 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1952 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1953 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1954 across all peers.
1955
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001956 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1957 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001958
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001959 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
1960 "server" keyword explanation below).
1961
1962server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
1963 As previously mentionned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
1964 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
1965 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
1966 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
1967 of this "peers" section).
1968 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
1969
1970
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001971 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001972 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001973 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001974 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1975 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1976 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001977
1978 backend mybackend
1979 mode tcp
1980 balance roundrobin
1981 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1982 stick on src
1983
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001984 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1985 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001986
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001987 Example:
1988 peers mypeers
1989 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
1990 default-server ssl verify none
1991 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
1992 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001993
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090019943.6. Mailers
1995------------
1996It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1997If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1998in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1999
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002000mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002001 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2002 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2003
2004mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2005 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2006
2007 Example:
2008 mailers mymailers
2009 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2010 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2011
2012 backend mybackend
2013 mode tcp
2014 balance roundrobin
2015
2016 email-alert mailers mymailers
2017 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2018 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2019
2020 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2021 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2022
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002023timeout mail <time>
2024 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2025 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2026 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2027 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2028
2029 Example:
2030 mailers mymailers
2031 timeout mail 20s
2032 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002033
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020344. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002035----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002036
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002037Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002038 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002039 - frontend <name>
2040 - backend <name>
2041 - listen <name>
2042
2043A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2044its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2045section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002046section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002047
2048A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2049connections.
2050
2051A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2052to forward incoming connections.
2053
2054A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2055parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2056
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002057All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2058'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2059case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2060
2061Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2062logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2063proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2064However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2065name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2066
2067Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2068and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002069bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002070protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2071modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2072arbitrary criteria.
2073
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002074In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2075a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002076the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002077
2078 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2079 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2080 between responses and new requests.
2081
2082 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2083 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2084 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002085 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2086 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2087 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2088 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002089
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002090 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2091 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2092 client-facing connection remains open.
2093
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002094 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2095 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002096
2097The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2098frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2099following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002100weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002101
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002102 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002103
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002104 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2105 ----+-----+-----+----
2106 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2107 ----+-----+-----+----
2108 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2109 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2110 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2111 ----+-----+-----+----
2112 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002113
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002114
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002115
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021164.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2117--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002118
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002119The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2120limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2121they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2122limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002123marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002124option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002125and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2126with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2127specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002128
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002129
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002130 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2131------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2132acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002133appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002134backlog X X X -
2135balance X - X X
2136bind - X X -
2137bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002138block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002139capture cookie - X X -
2140capture request header - X X -
2141capture response header - X X -
2142clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002143compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002144contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2145cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002146declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002147default-server X - X X
2148default_backend X X X -
2149description - X X X
2150disabled X X X X
2151dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002152email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002153email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002154email-alert mailers X X X X
2155email-alert myhostname X X X X
2156email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002157enabled X X X X
2158errorfile X X X X
2159errorloc X X X X
2160errorloc302 X X X X
2161-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2162errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002163force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002164filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002165fullconn X - X X
2166grace X X X X
2167hash-type X - X X
2168http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002169http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002170http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002171http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002172http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002173http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002174http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002175id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002176ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002177load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002178log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002179log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002180log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002181log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002182max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002183maxconn X X X -
2184mode X X X X
2185monitor fail - X X -
2186monitor-net X X X -
2187monitor-uri X X X -
2188option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2189option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2190option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2191option allbackups (*) X - X X
2192option checkcache (*) X - X X
2193option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2194option contstats (*) X X X -
2195option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2196option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002197option forceclose (deprectated) (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002198-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2199option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002200option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002201option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002202option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002203option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002204option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002205option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002206option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002207option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002208option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002209option httpchk X - X X
2210option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002211option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002212option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002213option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002214option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002215option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002216option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2217option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2218option logasap (*) X X X -
2219option mysql-check X - X X
2220option nolinger (*) X X X X
2221option originalto X X X X
2222option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002223option pgsql-check X - X X
2224option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002225option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002226option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002227option smtpchk X - X X
2228option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2229option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2230option splice-request (*) X X X X
2231option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002232option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002233option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2234option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2235-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002236option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002237option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2238option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2239option tcpka X X X X
2240option tcplog X X X X
2241option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002242external-check command X - X X
2243external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002244persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2245rate-limit sessions X X X -
2246redirect - X X X
2247redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2248redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2249reqadd - X X X
2250reqallow - X X X
2251reqdel - X X X
2252reqdeny - X X X
2253reqiallow - X X X
2254reqidel - X X X
2255reqideny - X X X
2256reqipass - X X X
2257reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002258reqitarpit - X X X
2259reqpass - X X X
2260reqrep - X X X
2261-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002262reqtarpit - X X X
2263retries X - X X
2264rspadd - X X X
2265rspdel - X X X
2266rspdeny - X X X
2267rspidel - X X X
2268rspideny - X X X
2269rspirep - X X X
2270rsprep - X X X
2271server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002272server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002273server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002274source X - X X
2275srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002276stats admin - X X X
2277stats auth X X X X
2278stats enable X X X X
2279stats hide-version X X X X
2280stats http-request - X X X
2281stats realm X X X X
2282stats refresh X X X X
2283stats scope X X X X
2284stats show-desc X X X X
2285stats show-legends X X X X
2286stats show-node X X X X
2287stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002288-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2289stick match - - X X
2290stick on - - X X
2291stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002292stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002293stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002294tcp-check connect - - X X
2295tcp-check expect - - X X
2296tcp-check send - - X X
2297tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002298tcp-request connection - X X -
2299tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002300tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002301tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002302tcp-response content - - X X
2303tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002304timeout check X - X X
2305timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002306timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002307timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2308timeout connect X - X X
2309timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2310timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2311timeout http-request X X X X
2312timeout queue X - X X
2313timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002314timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002315timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2316timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002317timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002318transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002319unique-id-format X X X -
2320unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002321use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002322use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002323------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2324 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002325
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002326
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023274.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2328---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002329
2330This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2331
2332
2333acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2334 Declare or complete an access list.
2335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2336 no | yes | yes | yes
2337 Example:
2338 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2339 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2340 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002342 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002343
2344
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002345appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2346 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002347 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2349 no | no | yes | yes
2350 Arguments :
2351 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2352 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2353
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002354 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002355 checked in each cookie value.
2356
2357 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2358 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2359 milliseconds.
2360
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002361 request-learn
2362 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2363 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2364 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2365 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2366 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2367 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2368
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002369 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2370 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2371 data following this prefix.
2372
2373 Example :
2374 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2375
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002376 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXX=XXXX,
2377 the appsession value will be XXX=XXXX.
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002378
2379 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2380 2 modes are currently supported :
2381 - path-parameters :
2382 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2383 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2384 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2385 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2386 - query-string :
2387 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2388 query string.
2389
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002390 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2391 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2392 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002393
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002394 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2395 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002396
2397
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002398backlog <conns>
2399 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2401 yes | yes | yes | no
2402 Arguments :
2403 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2404 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002405 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002406
2407 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2408 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2409 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2410 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2411 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2412 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2413 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2414 backlog parameter.
2415
2416 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2417 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2418 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2419
2420 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2421
2422
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002423balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002424balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002425 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2427 yes | no | yes | yes
2428 Arguments :
2429 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2430 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2431 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2432 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2433
2434 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2435 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2436 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2437 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002438 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002439 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002440 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2441 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2442 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2443 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2444 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2445 it, so that you don't worry.
2446
2447 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2448 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2449 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2450 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2451 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2452 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2453 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2454 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002455
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002456 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2457 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2458 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2459 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2460 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2461 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2462 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2463 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2464
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002465 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002466 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002467 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2468 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002469 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002470 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2471 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2472 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2473 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2474 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002475 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2476 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2477 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2478 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2479 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2480 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002481
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002482 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2483 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2484 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2485 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2486 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2487 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2488 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2489 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002490 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002491 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002492 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2493 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2494 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002495
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002496 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2497 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2498 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2499 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2500 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2501 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2502 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2503 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2504 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2505 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2506 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2507 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002508
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002509 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002510 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2511 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2512 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2513 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2514 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2515 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2516 URIs start with a leading "/".
2517
2518 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2519 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2520 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2521 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2522
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002523 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002524 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2525
2526 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002527 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2528 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002529 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2530 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2531 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2532 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002533 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002534 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2535 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002536
2537 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2538 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2539 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2540 server will receive the request.
2541
2542 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2543 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2544 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2545 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2546 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002547 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2548 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2549 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002550
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002551 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2552 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2553 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2554 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2555 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002556
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002557 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002558 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2559 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2560 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2561
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002562 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2563 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2564 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2565
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002566 random
2567 random(<draws>)
2568 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002569 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2570 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2571 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2572 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002573 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2574 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2575 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2576 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2577 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2578 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2579 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2580 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2581 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2582 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2583 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2584 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2585 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2586 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2587 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2588 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2589 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2590 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2591 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2592 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002593
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002594 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002595 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002596 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2597 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2598 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2599 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2600 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2601 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002602 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002603 used instead.
2604
2605 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2606 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2607 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2608 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2609
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002610 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2611 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2612 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2613
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002614 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002615
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002616 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002617 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2618 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002619
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002620 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2621 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2622 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002623
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002624 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2625 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2626 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2627 NTLM relies on.
2628
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002629 Examples :
2630 balance roundrobin
2631 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002632 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002633 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2634 balance hdr(host)
2635 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002636
2637 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2638 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2639
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002640 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002641 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2642 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2643 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2644 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2645
2646 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2647 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2648 defaults to 16 kB.
2649
2650 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2651 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2652
2653 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2654 Round Robin.
2655
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002656 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002657 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2658 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2659 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2660
2661 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2662
2663 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002664 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002665 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2666 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2667 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002668
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002669 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002670
2671
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002672bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2673bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002674 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2676 no | yes | yes | no
2677 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002678 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2679 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2680 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2681 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002682 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002683 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2684 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2685 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2686 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2687 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2688 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2689 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002690 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2691 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2692 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2693 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2694 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2695 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2696 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002697 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2698 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2699 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002700 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2701 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2702 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2703 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002704 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2705 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2706 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002707
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002708 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2709 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002710 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2711 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2712 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002713 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2714 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2715 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2716 the range.
2717
2718 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2719 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2720 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2721 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2722 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2723 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2724 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002725 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002726 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002727
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002728 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002729 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002730 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2731 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2732 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2733 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2734 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2735 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2736
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002737 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2738 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2739 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2740 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002741
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002742 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2743 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2744 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2745 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2746 in a frontend.
2747
2748 Example :
2749 listen http_proxy
2750 bind :80,:443
2751 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002752 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002753
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002754 listen http_https_proxy
2755 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002756 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002757
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002758 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2759 bind ipv6@:80
2760 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2761 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2762
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002763 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002764 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002765
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002766 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2767 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2768 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2769 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2770 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2771
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002772 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002773 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002774
2775
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002776bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002777 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2779 yes | yes | yes | yes
2780 Arguments :
2781 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2782 may be used to override a default value.
2783
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002784 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002785 option may be combined with other numbers.
2786
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002787 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002788 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2789 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2790 missing from all processes.
2791
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002792 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002793 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002794 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2795 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2796 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2797 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2798 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002799 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002800
2801 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2802 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2803 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2804 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2805 and 'even' instances.
2806
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002807 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2808 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2809 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2810 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002811
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002812 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2813 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2814
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002815 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2816 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2817 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2818
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002819 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2820 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2821
2822 Example :
2823 listen app_ip1
2824 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002825 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002826
2827 listen app_ip2
2828 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002829 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002830
2831 listen management
2832 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002833 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002834
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002835 listen management
2836 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2837 bind-process 1-4
2838
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002839 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002840
2841
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002842block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002843 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2845 no | yes | yes | yes
2846
2847 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2848 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002849 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002850 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002851 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002852 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2853 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2854 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002855
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002856 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2857 "http-request deny" instead.
2858
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002859 Example:
2860 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2861 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2862 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002863 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2864 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2865 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002866
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002867 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2868 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2869 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002870
2871capture cookie <name> len <length>
2872 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2874 no | yes | yes | no
2875 Arguments :
2876 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2877 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2878 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2879 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002880 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002881
2882 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2883 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2884 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2885 right if it exceeds <length>.
2886
2887 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2888 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2889 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2890 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2891
2892 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2893 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2894 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2895
2896 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2897 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2898 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002899 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2900 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2901 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002902
2903 Example:
2904 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2905
2906 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002907 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002908
2909
2910capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002911 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2913 no | yes | yes | no
2914 Arguments :
2915 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002916 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002917 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2918 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2919 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2920
2921 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2922 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2923 it exceeds <length>.
2924
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002925 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002926 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2927 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002928 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2929 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2930 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2931 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002932 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002933 environments to find where the request came from.
2934
2935 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2936 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2937 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2938 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002939
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002940 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2941 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2942 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2943 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2944 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002945
2946 Example:
2947 capture request header Host len 15
2948 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002949 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002951 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002952 about logging.
2953
2954
2955capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002956 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2958 no | yes | yes | no
2959 Arguments :
2960 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002961 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002962 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2963 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2964 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2965
2966 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2967 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2968 it exceeds <length>.
2969
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002970 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002971 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2972 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2973 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002974 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2975 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2976 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2977 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002978
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002979 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2980 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2981 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2982 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2983 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002984
2985 Example:
2986 capture response header Content-length len 9
2987 capture response header Location len 15
2988
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002989 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002990 about logging.
2991
2992
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002993clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002994 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2996 yes | yes | yes | no
2997 Arguments :
2998 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2999 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3000 as explained at the top of this document.
3001
3002 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3003 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3004 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3005 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3006 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3007 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3008 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3009 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003010 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003011 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003012 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003013
3014 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3015 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3016 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3017 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3018 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3019 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3020
3021 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3022 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3023
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003024 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3025 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003026
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003027compression algo <algorithm> ...
3028compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003029compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003030 Enable HTTP compression.
3031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3032 yes | yes | yes | yes
3033 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003034 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3035 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3036 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3037
3038 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003039 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3040 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3041 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003042
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003043 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003044 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003045
3046 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3047 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3048 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3049 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3050 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003051 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003052
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003053 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3054 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3055 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3056 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3057 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3058 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3059 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003060 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003061
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003062 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003063 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003064 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3065 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3066 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3067 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3068 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003069
3070 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3071 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3072 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3073 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3074 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003075 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3076 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3077 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3078 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3079 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003080 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3081 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003082
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003083 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003084 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3085 "Accept-Encoding" header
3086 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003087 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003088 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3089 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3090 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3091 "multipart"
3092 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3093 header
3094 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3095 and later
3096 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3097 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003098 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003099
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003100 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003101
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003102 Examples :
3103 compression algo gzip
3104 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003106
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003107contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003108 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3110 yes | no | yes | yes
3111 Arguments :
3112 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3113 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3114 as explained at the top of this document.
3115
3116 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003117 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003118 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003119 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003120 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3121 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3122 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3123
3124 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3125 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3126 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3127 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3128 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3129 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3130
3131 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3132 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3133 instead.
3134
3135 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3136 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3137
3138
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003139cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003140 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3141 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003142 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003143 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3145 yes | no | yes | yes
3146 Arguments :
3147 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3148 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3149 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3150 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3151 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3152 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003153 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003154 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3155 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3156
3157 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3158 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3159 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3160 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3161 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3162 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003163 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3164 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003165 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003166 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3167 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003168
3169 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003170 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003171
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003172 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003173 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3174 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003175 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003176 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3177 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3178 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3179 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3180 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3181 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3182 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003183
3184 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3185 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3186 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3187 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3188 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3189 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3190 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3191 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3192 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003193 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003194 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3195 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3196 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003197
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003198 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3199 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3200 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003201 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3202 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3203 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3204 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003205 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3206 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3207 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003208
3209 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3210 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3211 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3212 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3213 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3214 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3215 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3216 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3217 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3218
3219 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3220 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3221 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3222 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3223 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3224 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3225 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3226 persistence cookie in the cache.
3227 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3228
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003229 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3230 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3231 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3232 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3233 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003234 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003235 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3236 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3237 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3238 they logout.
3239
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003240 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3241 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3242 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3243 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3244
3245 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3246 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3247 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3248 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3249 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3250 this attribute.
3251
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003252 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003253 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003254 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3255 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3256 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3257 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3258 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3259 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003260
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003261 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3262 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3263 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3264 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3265 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3266 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3267 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3268 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003269 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003270 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3271 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3272 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3273 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3274 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3275 the site.
3276
3277 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3278 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3279 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3280 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3281 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3282 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3283 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3284 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3285 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3286 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3287 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3288 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3289 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003290 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003291 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3292 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3293
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003294 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3295 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3296 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3297 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3298 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3299 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3300
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003301 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3302 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3303 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3304 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003305
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003306 Examples :
3307 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3308 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3309 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003310 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003311
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003312 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003313
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003314
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003315declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3316 Declares a capture slot.
3317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3318 no | yes | yes | no
3319 Arguments:
3320 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3321
3322 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3323 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3324 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3325 for use in the response.
3326
3327 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003328 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003329 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3330
3331
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003332default-server [param*]
3333 Change default options for a server in a backend
3334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3335 yes | no | yes | yes
3336 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003337 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3338 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3339 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3340 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003341
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003342 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003343 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3344
3345 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003346
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003347
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003348default_backend <backend>
3349 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3351 yes | yes | yes | no
3352 Arguments :
3353 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3354
3355 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3356 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3357 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3358 will catch all undetermined requests.
3359
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003360 Example :
3361
3362 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3363 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3364 default_backend dynamic
3365
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003366 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003367
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003368
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003369description <string>
3370 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3372 no | yes | yes | yes
3373 Arguments : string
3374
3375 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3376 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3377 it describes.
3378 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3379
3380
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003381disabled
3382 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3384 yes | yes | yes | yes
3385 Arguments : none
3386
3387 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3388 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3389 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3390 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3391 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3392 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3393 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3394
3395 See also : "enabled"
3396
3397
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003398dispatch <address>:<port>
3399 Set a default server address
3400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3401 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003402 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003403
3404 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3405 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3406 during start-up.
3407
3408 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3409 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3410 possible with normal servers.
3411
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003412 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003413 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3414 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3415 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3416 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3417
3418 See also : "server"
3419
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003420
3421dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3422 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3424 yes | no | yes | yes
3425 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3426
3427 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003428 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003429 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3430 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003431 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003432 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003433
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003434enabled
3435 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3437 yes | yes | yes | yes
3438 Arguments : none
3439
3440 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3441 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3442
3443 See also : "disabled"
3444
3445
3446errorfile <code> <file>
3447 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3449 yes | yes | yes | yes
3450 Arguments :
3451 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003452 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3453 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003454
3455 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003456 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003457 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003458 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3459 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003460
3461 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3462 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3463 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3464
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003465 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3466
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003467 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3468 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3469 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3470 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3471
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003472 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3473 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003474 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003475 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3476 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3477 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3478
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003479 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3480 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3481 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003482 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003483 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3484
3485 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3486
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003487 Example :
3488 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003489 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003490 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3491 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3492
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003493
3494errorloc <code> <url>
3495errorloc302 <code> <url>
3496 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3498 yes | yes | yes | yes
3499 Arguments :
3500 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003501 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3502 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003503
3504 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3505 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3506 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3507 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003508 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003509
3510 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3511 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3512 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3513
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003514 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3515
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003516 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3517 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3518 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3519 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003520 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003521 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3522 request.
3523
3524 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3525
3526
3527errorloc303 <code> <url>
3528 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3530 yes | yes | yes | yes
3531 Arguments :
3532 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003533 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3534 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003535
3536 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3537 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3538 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3539 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003540 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003541
3542 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3543 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3544 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3545
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003546 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3547
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003548 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3549 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3550 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3551 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003552 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003553
3554 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3555
3556
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003557email-alert from <emailaddr>
3558 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003559 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003560 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3561 yes | yes | yes | yes
3562
3563 Arguments :
3564
3565 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3566
3567 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3568 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3569
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003570 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003571 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3572 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003573
3574
3575email-alert level <level>
3576 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3577 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3578 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3579 yes | yes | yes | yes
3580
3581 Arguments :
3582
3583 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3584 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3585 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3586
3587 By default level is alert
3588
3589 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3590 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3591 for the proxy.
3592
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003593 Alerts are sent when :
3594
3595 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3596 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3597 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3598 is notice or lower
3599 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3600 and a health check status update occurs
3601
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003602 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3603 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003604 section 3.6 about mailers.
3605
3606
3607email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3608 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3609 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3610 yes | yes | yes | yes
3611
3612 Arguments :
3613
3614 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3615
3616 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3617 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3618
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003619 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3620 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003621
3622
3623email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3624 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3625 mailers.
3626 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3627 yes | yes | yes | yes
3628
3629 Arguments :
3630
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003631 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003632
3633 By default the systems hostname is used.
3634
3635 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3636 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3637 for the proxy.
3638
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003639 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3640 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003641
3642
3643email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003644 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003645 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3646 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3647 yes | yes | yes | yes
3648
3649 Arguments :
3650
3651 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3652
3653 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3654 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3655
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003656 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003657 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3658
3659
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003660force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3661 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3662 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003663 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003664
3665 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3666 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3667 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3668 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3669 marked down for maintenance operations.
3670
3671 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3672 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3673 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3674 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3675 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3676 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3677 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3678 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3679 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3680
3681 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3682 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3683 is used.
3684
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003685 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003686 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003687
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003688
3689filter <name> [param*]
3690 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3692 no | yes | yes | yes
3693 Arguments :
3694 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3695 referenced in section 9.
3696
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003697 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003698 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003699 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3700 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003701
3702 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3703 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3704
3705 Example:
3706 listen
3707 bind *:80
3708
3709 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3710 filter compression
3711 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3712
3713 compression algo gzip
3714 compression offload
3715
3716 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3717
3718 See also : section 9.
3719
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003720
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003721fullconn <conns>
3722 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3724 yes | no | yes | yes
3725 Arguments :
3726 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3727 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3728
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003729 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003730 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003731 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003732 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3733 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3734 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3735 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3736 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003737 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003738
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003739 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3740 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003741 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3742 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3743 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003744
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003745 Example :
3746 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3747 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3748 # connections.
3749 backend dynamic
3750 fullconn 10000
3751 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3752 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3753
3754 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3755
3756
3757grace <time>
3758 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003760 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003761 Arguments :
3762 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3763 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3764 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3765
3766 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3767 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003768 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003769 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3770
3771 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3772 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3773 simplify it.
3774
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003775
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003776hash-balance-factor <factor>
3777 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3779 yes | no | no | yes
3780 Arguments :
3781 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3782 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003783 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003784
3785 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3786 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3787 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3788 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3789 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3790 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3791 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3792
3793 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3794 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3795 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3796 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3797 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3798
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003799 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3800 consistent hashing mechanism.
3801
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003802 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3803
3804
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003805hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003806 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3808 yes | no | yes | yes
3809 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003810 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3811 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003812
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003813 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3814 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3815 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3816 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3817 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3818 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3819 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3820 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3821 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3822 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003823
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003824 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3825 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3826 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3827 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3828 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3829 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3830 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3831 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3832 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3833 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3834 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3835 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3836 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003837 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3838 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003839
3840 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3841
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003842 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003843 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3844 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3845 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003846 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3847 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3848 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003849
3850 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3851 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003852 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3853 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3854 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3855 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3856
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003857 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3858 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3859 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3860 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3861 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3862 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3863 parameter.
3864
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003865 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3866 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3867 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3868 used on strings.
3869
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003870 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3871
3872 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3873 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3874 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3875 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3876 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3877 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3878 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3879 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3880 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3881 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3882 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3883 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003884
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003885 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3886 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3887 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003888
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003889 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003890
3891
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003892http-check disable-on-404
3893 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003895 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003896 Arguments : none
3897
3898 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3899 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3900 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3901 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3902 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3903 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3904 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3905 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003906 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3907 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3908 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3909
3910 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3911
3912
3913http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003914 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003916 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003917 Arguments :
3918 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3919 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003920 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003921 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3922 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3923 details on the supported keywords.
3924
3925 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3926 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3927 with the usual backslash ('\').
3928
3929 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3930 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3931 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3932 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3933 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3934
3935 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003936 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003937 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3938 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3939 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3940
3941 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003942 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003943 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3944 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3945 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3946 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3947
3948 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003949 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003950 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3951 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3952 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3953 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3954 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003955 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003956 trace).
3957
3958 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003959 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003960 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3961 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3962 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3963 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3964 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003965 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003966
3967 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3968 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3969 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3970 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3971 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3972 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3973 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3974 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3975
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003976 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3977 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3978 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3979
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003980 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3981 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3982
3983 Examples :
3984 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003985 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003986
3987 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003988 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003989
3990 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003991 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003992
3993 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003994 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003995
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003996 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003997
3998
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003999http-check send-state
4000 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4002 yes | no | yes | yes
4003 Arguments : none
4004
4005 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4006 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4007 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4008 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4009 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4010
4011 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4012 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4013 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4014 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4015 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004016 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4017 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4018 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4019
4020 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4021 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4022 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4023
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004024 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4025 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4026 checked in multiple backends.
4027
4028 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4029 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4030
4031 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4032 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4033 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4034 one fails.
4035
4036 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4037 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4038 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4039
4040 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4041 server's queue.
4042
4043 Example of a header received by the application server :
4044 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4045 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4046
4047 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4048
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004049
4050http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004051 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4052
4053 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4054 no | yes | yes | yes
4055
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004056 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4057 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4058 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4059 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4060 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004061
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004062 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4063 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004064
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004065 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004066
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004067 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4068 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4069 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4070 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004071
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004072 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4073 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4074 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4075 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004076
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004077 Example:
4078 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4079 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4080 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004081
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004082 http-request allow if nagios
4083 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4084 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4085 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004086
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004087 Example:
4088 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4089 acl add path /addacl
4090 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004091
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004092 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004093
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004094 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4095 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004096
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004097 Example:
4098 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4099 acl setmap path /setmap
4100 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004101
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004102 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004103
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004104 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4105 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004106
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004107 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4108 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004109
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004110http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004111
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004112 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4113 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4114 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4115 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4116 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4117 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4118 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4119 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004120
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004121http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004122
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004123 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4124 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4125 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4126 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4127 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4128 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4129 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4130 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004131
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004132http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004133
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004134 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4135 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004136
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004137
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004138http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004139
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004140 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4141 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4142 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4143 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4144 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004145
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004146 Example:
4147 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4148 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004149
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004150http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004151
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004152 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004153
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004154http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4155 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004156
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004157 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4158 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4159 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4160 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4161 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4162 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4163 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4164 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4165 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004166
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004167 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4168 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4169 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4170 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4171 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4172 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004173
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004174http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004175
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004176 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4177 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4178 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4179 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4180 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4181 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004182
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004183http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004184
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004185 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004186
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004187http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004188
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004189 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4190 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4191 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4192 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4193 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4194 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004195
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004196http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004197
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004198 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4199 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4200 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4201 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4202 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004203
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004204http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4205
4206 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4207 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4208 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4209 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004210 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4211 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004212
4213 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4214
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004215http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004216
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004217 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4218 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4219 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4220 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4221 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004222
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004223http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004224
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004225 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4226 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4227 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4228 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004229
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004230http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4231 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004232
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004233 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4234 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4235 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4236 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4237 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4238 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4239 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4240 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004241
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004242 Example:
4243 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004244
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004245 # applied to:
4246 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004247
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004248 # outputs:
4249 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004250
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004251 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004252
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004253http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4254 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004255
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004256 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4257 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4258 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4259 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004260
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004261 Example:
4262 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004263
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004264 # applied to:
4265 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004266
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004267 # outputs:
4268 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004269
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004270http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4271http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004272
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004273 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4274 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4275 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004276
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004277http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004278
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004279 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4280 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4281 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004282
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004283http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004284
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004285 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4286 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4287 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4288 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4289 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004290
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004291 Arguments:
4292 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4293 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004294
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004295 Example:
4296 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4297 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004298
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004299 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4300 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004301
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004302http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004303
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004304 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4305 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4306 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004307
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004308 Arguments:
4309 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4310 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004311
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004312 Example:
4313 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4314 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004315
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004316 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4317 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4318 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004319
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004320http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004321
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004322 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4323 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4324 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4325 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4326 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004327
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004328 Example:
4329 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4330 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4331 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4332 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4333 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4334 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4335 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4336 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4337 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004338
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004339http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004340
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004341 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4342 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4343 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4344 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4345 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004346
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004347http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4348 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004349
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004350 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4351 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4352 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4353 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4354 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4355 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4356 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4357 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4358 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004359
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004360http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004361
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004362 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4363 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4364 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4365 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4366 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4367 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4368 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004369
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004370http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004371
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004372 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4373 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4374 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004375
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004376http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004378 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4379 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4380 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4381 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4382 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4383 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4384 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4385 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004386
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004387http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004388
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004389 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4390 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4391 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4392 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4393 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4394 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004395
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004396 Example :
4397 # prepend the host name before the path
4398 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004399
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004400http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004401
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004402 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4403 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4404 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4405 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4406 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004407
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004408http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004409
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004410 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4411 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4412 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4413 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4414 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4415 values have higher priority.
4416 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4417 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4418 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4419 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4420 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004421
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004422http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004423
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004424 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4425 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4426 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4427 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4428 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4429 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4430 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004431
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004432 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004433
4434 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004435 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4436 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004437
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004438http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4439 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4440 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4441 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4442 privacy.
4443
4444 Arguments :
4445 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4446 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004447
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004448 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004449 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4450 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4451
4452 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4453 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4454
4455http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4456
4457 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4458 expression.
4459
4460 Arguments:
4461 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4462 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004463
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004464 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004465 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4466 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4467
4468 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4469 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4470 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4471
4472http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4473
4474 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4475 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4476 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4477 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4478 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4479 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4480 information from the request.
4481
4482 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4483
4484http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4485
4486 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4487 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4488 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4489 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4490 path and the query string.
4491 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4492
4493http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4494
4495 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4496 inline.
4497
4498 Arguments:
4499 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4500 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4501 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4502 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4503 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4504 (request and response)
4505 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4506 processing
4507 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4508 processing
4509 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4510 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4511 and '_'.
4512
4513 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4514 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004515
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004516 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004517 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004518
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004519http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4520 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004521
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004522 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4523 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4524 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4525 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4526 agent name must be used.
4527
4528 Arguments:
4529 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4530
4531 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4532 configuration.
4533
4534http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4535
4536 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4537 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4538 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4539 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4540 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4541 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4542 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4543 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4544 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4545 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4546 action.
4547 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4548 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4549 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4550 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4551 you fully understand how it works.
4552
4553http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4554
4555 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4556 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4557 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4558 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4559 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4560 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4561 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4562 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4563 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4564 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4565 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4566 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4567 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4568
4569http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4570http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4571http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4572
4573 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4574 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4575 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4576 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4577 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4578 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4579 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4580 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4581 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4582 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4583 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4584 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4585
4586 Arguments :
4587 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4588 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4589 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4590 select which table entry to update the counters.
4591
4592 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4593 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4594 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4595 that table until the session ends.
4596
4597 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4598 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4599 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4600 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4601 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4602 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4603 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4604 useful information.
4605
4606 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4607 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4608 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4609 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4610 checks that make use of it.
4611
4612http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4613
4614 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004615
4616 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004617 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004619http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004620
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004621 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4622 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4623 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004624
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004625
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004626http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004627 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4628
4629 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4630 no | yes | yes | yes
4631
4632 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4633 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4634 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4635 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4636 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4637 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4638
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004639 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4640 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004641
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004642 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004643
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004644 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4645 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4646 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4647 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004648
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004649 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4650 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4651 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4652 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004653
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004654 Example:
4655 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004656
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004657 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004658
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004659 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4660 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004661
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004662 Example:
4663 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004664
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004665 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004666
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004667 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4668 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004669
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004670 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4671 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004672
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004673http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004674
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004675 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4676 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4677 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4678 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4679 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4680 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4681 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4682 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004683
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004684http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004685
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004686 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4687 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4688 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4689 example, or to pass some internal information.
4690 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4691 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4692 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004693
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004694http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004695
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004696 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4697 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004698
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004699http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004700
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004701 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004702
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004703http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004704
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004705 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4706 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4707 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4708 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4709 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4710 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4711 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004712
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004713 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4714 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4715 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4716 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4717 keyword.
4718 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4719 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004720
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004721http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004722
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004723 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4724 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4725 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4726 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4727 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4728 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004729
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004730http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004731
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004732 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004733
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004734http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004735
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004736 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4737 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4738 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4739 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4740 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4741 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004742
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004743http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004744
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004745 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4746 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004747
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004748http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004749
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004750 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4751 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4752 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4753 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4754 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4755 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004756
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004757http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4758 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004759
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004760 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4761 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4762 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4763 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4764 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4765 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4766 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4767 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004768
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004769 Example:
4770 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004771
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004772 # applied to:
4773 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004774
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004775 # outputs:
4776 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004777
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004778 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004779
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004780http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4781 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004782
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004783 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4784 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4785 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4786 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004787
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004788 Example:
4789 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004790
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004791 # applied to:
4792 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004793
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004794 # outputs:
4795 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004796
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004797http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4798http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004799
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004800 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4801 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4802 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004803
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004804http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004805
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004806 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4807 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4808 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004809
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004810http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004811
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004812 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4813 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4814 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4815 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4816 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004817
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004818 Arguments:
4819 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004820
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004821 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4822 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004823
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004824http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004825
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004826 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4827 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4828 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004829
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004830http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4831
4832 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4833 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4834 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4835 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4836 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4837
4838http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4839
4840 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4841 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4842 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4843 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4844 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4845 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4846 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4847 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
4848 be triggered by an HTTP response.
4849
4850http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4851
4852 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4853 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4854 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4855 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
4856 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
4857 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
4858 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
4859
4860http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4861
4862 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4863 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4864 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4865 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4866 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
4867 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4868 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4869 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4870
4871http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4872 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4873
4874 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4875 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4876 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4877 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004878
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004879 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004880 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4881 http-response set-status 431
4882 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4883 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004884
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004885http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004886
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004887 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4888 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4889 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4890 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
4891 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
4892 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
4893 based on some information from the request.
4894
4895 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4896
4897http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4898
4899 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4900 inline.
4901
4902 Arguments:
4903 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4904 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4905 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4906 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4907 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4908 (request and response)
4909 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4910 processing
4911 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4912 processing
4913 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4914 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4915 and '_'.
4916
4917 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4918 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004919
4920 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004921 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004922
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004923http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004924
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004925 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4926 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4927 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4928 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4929 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4930 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4931 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4932 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4933 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4934 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4935 action.
4936 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4937 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4938 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4939 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4940 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004941
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004942http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4943http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4944http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004945
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004946 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
4947 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4948 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
4949 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
4950 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
4951 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4952
4953http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4954
4955 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
4956 about <var-name>.
4957
4958 Example:
4959 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4960
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004961
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004962http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4963 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4964
4965 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4966 yes | no | yes | yes
4967
4968 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01004969 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
4970 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
4971 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004972
4973 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4974
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01004975 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
4976 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
4977 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
4978 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
4979 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
4980 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
4981 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
4982 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
4983 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
4984 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004985
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01004986 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
4987 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
4988 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
4989 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
4990 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
4991 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
4992 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
4993 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004994
4995 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4996 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4997 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4998 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4999 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5000 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5001 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5002 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
5003 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
5004 downsides of rare connection failures.
5005
5006 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5007 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5008 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5009 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5010 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5011 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005012 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005013 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5014 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5015 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5016 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5017 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5018
5019 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005020 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5021 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5022 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005023
5024 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005025 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005026
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005027 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5028 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005029
5030 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5031 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5032 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5033
5034 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5035 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5036 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5037
5038 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5039
5040
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005041http-send-name-header [<header>]
5042 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5043
5044 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5045 yes | no | yes | yes
5046
5047 Arguments :
5048
5049 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5050
5051 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005052 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005053 is added with the header string proved.
5054
5055 See also : "server"
5056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005057id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005058 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5060 no | yes | yes | yes
5061 Arguments : none
5062
5063 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5064 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5065 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005066
5067
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005068ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5069 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5070 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005071 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005072
5073 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5074 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5075 and running).
5076
5077 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5078 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5079 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005080 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005081 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5082
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005083 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5084 "unless" condition is met.
5085
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005086 Example:
5087 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5088 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5089 ignore-persist if url_static
5090
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005091 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5092
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005093load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5094 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5095 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5096 yes | no | yes | yes
5097
5098 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5099 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5100 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005101 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005102 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5103 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5104 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5105 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5106
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005107 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005108 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005109 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005110
5111 Arguments:
5112 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5113 named "server-state-file".
5114
5115 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5116 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5117 name is used as a file name.
5118
5119 none don't load any stat for this backend
5120
5121 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005122 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5123 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5124 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005125 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005126 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005127
5128 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5129 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5130
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005131 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005132
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005133 global
5134 stats socket /tmp/socket
5135 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005136
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005137 defaults
5138 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005139
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005140 backend bk
5141 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5142 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005143
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005144
5145 Then one can run :
5146
5147 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5148
5149 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5150
5151 1
5152 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5153 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5154 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5155
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005156 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005157
5158 global
5159 stats socket /tmp/socket
5160 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5161
5162 defaults
5163 load-server-state-from-file local
5164
5165 backend bk
5166 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5167 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5168
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005169
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005170 Then one can run :
5171
5172 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5173
5174 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5175
5176 1
5177 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5178 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5179 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5180
5181 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5182 "show servers state"
5183
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005184
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005185log global
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005186log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005187no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005188 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5190 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005191
5192 Prefix :
5193 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5194 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5195 prefix does not allow arguments.
5196
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005197 Arguments :
5198 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5199 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5200 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5201 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5202 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5203 parameter.
5204
5205 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5206 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5207
5208 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5209 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5210 standard syslog port).
5211
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005212 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5213 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5214 standard syslog port).
5215
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005216 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5217 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5218 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005219 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005220
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005221 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5222 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5223 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5224 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5225 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5226 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5227 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5228 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5229 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5230 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5231 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5232 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5233 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5234 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5235 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5236 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005237 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5238 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005239
5240 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5241 and "fd@2", see above.
5242
5243 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5244 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005245
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005246 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5247 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5248 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5249 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5250 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5251 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5252 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5253 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5254 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5255 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005256 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005257
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005258 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5259 one of the following :
5260
5261 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5262 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5263
5264 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5265 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5266
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005267 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5268 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5269 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5270 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5271 systemd logger consumes.
5272
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005273 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5274 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5275 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5276 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5277
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005278 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5279
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005280 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5281 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5282 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5283
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005284 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5285 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5286 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5287 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005288
5289 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5290 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5291 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005292 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5293 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5294 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5295 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5296 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005297
5298 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5299
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005300 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5301 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5302 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005303
5304 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5305 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5306 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5307 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5308
5309 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5310 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005311
5312 Example :
5313 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005314 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5315 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5316 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005317 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5318 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005319 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005320
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005321
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005322log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005323 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5324 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5325 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005326
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005327 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5328 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5329 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5330 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5331 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005332
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005333 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5334 "option httplog" directives.
5335
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005336log-format-sd <string>
5337 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5338 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5339 yes | yes | yes | no
5340
5341 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5342 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5343 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5344 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5345 which covers the log format string in depth.
5346
5347 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5348 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5349
5350 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5351 log format to "rfc5424".
5352
5353 Example :
5354 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5355
5356
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005357log-tag <string>
5358 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5359 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5360 yes | yes | yes | yes
5361
5362 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5363 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5364 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5365 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5366 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5367 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5368 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5369 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5370 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005371
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005372max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5373 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5374 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5375 yes | no | yes | yes
5376
5377 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5378 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5379 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5380 servers.
5381
5382 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5383 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5384 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5385 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5386 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005387 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005388 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5389 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5390 picking a different server.
5391
5392 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5393 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5394 even if they have to be queued.
5395
5396 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5397 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5398
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005399max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5400 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5401 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5402 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005403
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005404maxconn <conns>
5405 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5407 yes | yes | yes | no
5408 Arguments :
5409 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5410 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5411 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5412 closes.
5413
5414 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5415 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5416 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5417 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005418 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5419 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5420 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5421 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005422
5423 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5424 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5425 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5426
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005427 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5428 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005429
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005430 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5431
5432
5433mode { tcp|http|health }
5434 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5436 yes | yes | yes | yes
5437 Arguments :
5438 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5439 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5440 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5441 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5442
5443 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5444 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5445 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5446 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5447 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5448
5449 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005450 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5451 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5452 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5453 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5454 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5455 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5456 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005457
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005458 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5459 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5460 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005461
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005462 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005463 defaults http_instances
5464 mode http
5465
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005466 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005467
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005468
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005469monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005470 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5472 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005473 Arguments :
5474 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5475 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005476 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005477 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5478 backend and its backup.
5479
5480 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5481 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5482 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5483 servers in a list of backends.
5484
5485 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5486 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5487 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5488 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5489 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5490 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5491 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005492 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5493 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005494
5495 Example:
5496 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005497 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005498 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5499 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5500 monitor-uri /site_alive
5501 monitor fail if site_dead
5502
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005503 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005504
5505
5506monitor-net <source>
5507 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5509 yes | yes | yes | no
5510 Arguments :
5511 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5512 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5513 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5514 followed by a mask.
5515
5516 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5517 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005518 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005519 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5520
5521 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5522 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5523 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5524 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005525 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5526 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5527 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005528
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005529 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5530 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5531 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5532 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5533 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5534 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005535
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005536 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5537 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005538
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005539 Example :
5540 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5541 frontend www
5542 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5543
5544 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5545
5546
5547monitor-uri <uri>
5548 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5550 yes | yes | yes | no
5551 Arguments :
5552 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5553 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5554
5555 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5556 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5557 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5558 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5559 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5560 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5561 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5562 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5563
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005564 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5565 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5566 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5567 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5568 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5569 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5570 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5571 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005572
5573 Example :
5574 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5575 frontend www
5576 mode http
5577 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5578
5579 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5580
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005581
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005582option abortonclose
5583no option abortonclose
5584 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5586 yes | no | yes | yes
5587 Arguments : none
5588
5589 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5590 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5591 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5592 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005593 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005594 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5595 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5596 encountered while delivering the response.
5597
5598 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5599 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5600 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5601 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5602 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5603 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005604 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005605 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005606 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005607 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5608 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5609 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5610
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005611 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5612 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005613 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5614 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5615 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5616 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5617 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5618 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005619 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005620
5621 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5622 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5623
5624 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5625
5626
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005627option accept-invalid-http-request
5628no option accept-invalid-http-request
5629 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5631 yes | yes | yes | no
5632 Arguments : none
5633
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005634 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005635 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005636 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005637 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5638 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5639 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5640 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5641 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005642 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5643 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5644 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5645 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005646 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005647 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005648 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5649 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5650 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005651
5652 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5653 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5654 been confirmed.
5655
5656 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5657 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005658 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5659 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005660 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5661
5662 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5663 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5664
5665 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5666 stats socket.
5667
5668
5669option accept-invalid-http-response
5670no option accept-invalid-http-response
5671 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5673 yes | no | yes | yes
5674 Arguments : none
5675
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005676 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005677 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005678 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005679 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5680 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5681 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5682 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5683 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005684 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5685 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5686 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005687
5688 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5689 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5690 been confirmed.
5691
5692 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5693 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5694 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5695 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5696
5697 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5698 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5699
5700 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5701 stats socket.
5702
5703
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005704option allbackups
5705no option allbackups
5706 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5708 yes | no | yes | yes
5709 Arguments : none
5710
5711 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5712 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5713 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5714 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5715 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5716 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5717 order between the backup servers anymore.
5718
5719 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5720 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5721
5722 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5723 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5724
5725
5726option checkcache
5727no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005728 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5730 yes | no | yes | yes
5731 Arguments : none
5732
5733 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5734 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005735 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005736 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5737 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005738 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005739
5740 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005741 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005742 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005743 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5744 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005745 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005746 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005747 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5748 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005749 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005750 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5751 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005752 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005753 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5754 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5755 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5756 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5757 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5758 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5759 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5760 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5761 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5762
5763 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005764 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005765 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005766 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005767 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5768
5769 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5770 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005771 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005772 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005773
5774 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5775 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5776
5777
5778option clitcpka
5779no option clitcpka
5780 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5782 yes | yes | yes | no
5783 Arguments : none
5784
5785 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5786 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005787 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005788 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5789
5790 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5791 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5792 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5793 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5794
5795 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5796 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5797 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5798 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5799 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5800
5801 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5802
5803 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5804 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5805 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5806
5807 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5808 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5809
5810 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5811
5812
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005813option contstats
5814 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5816 yes | yes | yes | no
5817 Arguments : none
5818
5819 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5820 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5821 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5822 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005823 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5824 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5825 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5826 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5827 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005828
5829
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005830option dontlog-normal
5831no option dontlog-normal
5832 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5834 yes | yes | yes | no
5835 Arguments : none
5836
5837 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5838 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5839 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5840 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5841 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5842 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5843 logged.
5844
5845 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5846 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5847 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5848
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005849 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005850 logging.
5851
5852
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005853option dontlognull
5854no option dontlognull
5855 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5857 yes | yes | yes | no
5858 Arguments : none
5859
5860 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5861 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5862 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5863 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5864 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5865 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005866 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5867 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5868 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005869
5870 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005871 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005872 would not be logged.
5873
5874 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5875 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5876
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005877 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5878 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005879
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005880
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005881option forceclose (deprecated)
5882no option forceclose (deprecated)
5883 This is an alias for "option httpclose". Thus this option is deprecated.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005884
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005885 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005886
5887
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005888option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005889 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5891 yes | yes | yes | yes
5892 Arguments :
5893 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5894 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005895 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005896 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005897
5898 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5899 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5900 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5901 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5902 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5903 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5904 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005905 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5906 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5907 possible that the client has already brought one.
5908
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005909 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005910 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005911 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005912 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005913 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005914 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005915
5916 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5917 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5918 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5919 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5920 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5921 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5922 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5923
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005924 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5925 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5926 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5927 are under the control of the end-user.
5928
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005929 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005930 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5931 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005932 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5933 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5934 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005935
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005936 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005937 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5938 frontend www
5939 mode http
5940 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5941
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005942 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5943 backend www
5944 mode http
5945 option forwardfor header X-Client
5946
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005947 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005948 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005949
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005950
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005951option http-buffer-request
5952no option http-buffer-request
5953 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5955 yes | yes | yes | yes
5956 Arguments : none
5957
5958 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5959 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5960 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5961 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5962 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5963 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5964 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5965 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005966 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005967 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5968 default.
5969
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005970 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005971
5972
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005973option http-ignore-probes
5974no option http-ignore-probes
5975 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5977 yes | yes | yes | no
5978 Arguments : none
5979
5980 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5981 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5982 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5983 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5984 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5985 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5986 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5987 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5988 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005989 was received over a connection before it was closed;
5990 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005991 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5992
5993 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5994 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5995 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5996 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5997 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5998 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5999 are often the only way to detect them.
6000
6001 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6002 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6003
6004 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6005
6006
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006007option http-keep-alive
6008no option http-keep-alive
6009 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6011 yes | yes | yes | yes
6012 Arguments : none
6013
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006014 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6015 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006016 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6017 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6018 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6019 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6020 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006021
6022 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6023 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006024 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6025 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6026 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6027 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6028 situations where this option may be useful :
6029
6030 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006031 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006032
6033 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6034 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6035
6036 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6037 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6038 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6039 request.
6040
6041 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6042 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006043 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6044 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6045 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006046
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006047 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6048 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6049 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6050 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6051 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6052 not set.
6053
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006054 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006055 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6056 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006057
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006058 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006059 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006060 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006061
6062
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006063option http-no-delay
6064no option http-no-delay
6065 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6067 yes | yes | yes | yes
6068 Arguments : none
6069
6070 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6071 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6072 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6073 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6074 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6075 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6076 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6077 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6078 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6079 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6080 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6081 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6082 affected.
6083
6084 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6085 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6086 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6087 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6088 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6089 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6090 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6091 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6092 latency environments.
6093
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006094 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6095
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006096
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006097option http-pretend-keepalive
6098no option http-pretend-keepalive
6099 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006101 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006102 Arguments : none
6103
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006104 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006105 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6106 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6107 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6108 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6109 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6110 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6111 consider the response complete.
6112
6113 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6114 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6115 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6116 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006117 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006118 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6119
6120 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6121 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6122 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6123 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6124 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6125 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6126 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6127
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006128 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6129 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6130 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6131 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6132 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6133 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006134
6135 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6136 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6137
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006138 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006139 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006140
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006141
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006142option http-server-close
6143no option http-server-close
6144 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6146 yes | yes | yes | yes
6147 Arguments : none
6148
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006149 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6150 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6151 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6152 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006153 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6154 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6155 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6156 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6157 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6158 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6159 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6160 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6161 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6162 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6163 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006164
6165 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6166 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6167 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6168 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006169 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6170 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006171
6172 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6173 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006174 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6175 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6176 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006177
6178 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6179 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6180
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006181 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6182 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006183
6184
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006185option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6186no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6187 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006189 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006190 Arguments : none
6191
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006192 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6193 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6194 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6195
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006196 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6197 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6198 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6199 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006200 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006201
6202 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006203 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006204 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6205 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6206 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6207 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6208 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6209 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6210 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006211
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006212 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6213 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6214 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6215 backend.
6216
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006217 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6218 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6219
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006220 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6221 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006222
6223
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006224option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006225no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006226 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6228 yes | yes | yes | no
6229 Arguments : none
6230
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006231 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006232 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6233 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6234 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6235 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6236 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6237 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6238
6239 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6240 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006241 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6242 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6243 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006244
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006245 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6246 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6247 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6248 front of an existing proxy.
6249
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006250 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6251
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006252 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006253
6254
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006255option http-use-htx
6256no option http-use-htx
6257 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6259 yes | yes | yes | yes
6260 Arguments : none
6261
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006262 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006263 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006264 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6265 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6266 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6267 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6268 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006269
6270 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6271 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6272 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6273 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006274 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6275 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6276 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6277 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006278
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006279 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6280 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6281 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6282 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6283 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006284
6285 See also : "mode http"
6286
6287
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006288option httpchk
6289option httpchk <uri>
6290option httpchk <method> <uri>
6291option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6292 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6294 yes | no | yes | yes
6295 Arguments :
6296 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6297 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6298 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6299 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6300 ones.
6301
6302 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6303 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6304 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6305
6306 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6307 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6308 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6309 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6310 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6311
6312 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6313 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6314 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6315 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6316 the lack of any response.
6317
6318 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6319
6320 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6321 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6322 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6323
6324 Examples :
6325 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6326 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6327 backend https_relay
6328 mode tcp
6329 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6330 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6331
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006332 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6333 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6334 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006335
6336
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006337option httpclose
6338no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006339 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6341 yes | yes | yes | yes
6342 Arguments : none
6343
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006344 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6345 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6346 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6347 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006348 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006349
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006350 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6351 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6352 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6353 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6354 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006355
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006356 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6357 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6358 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006359
6360 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6361 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006362 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006363 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6364 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6365 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006366
6367 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6368 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6369
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006370 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006371
6372
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006373option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006374 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006376 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006377 Arguments :
6378 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6379 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6380 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006381 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006382 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006383
6384 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6385 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6386 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6387 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6388 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6389 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6390 ports.
6391
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006392 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6393 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006394
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006395 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6396
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006397 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006398
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006399
6400option http_proxy
6401no option http_proxy
6402 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6404 yes | yes | yes | yes
6405 Arguments : none
6406
6407 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6408 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6409 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6410 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6411 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6412
6413 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6414 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006415 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6416 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006417
6418 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6419 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6420
6421 Example :
6422 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6423 backend direct_forward
6424 option httpclose
6425 option http_proxy
6426
6427 See also : "option httpclose"
6428
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006429
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006430option independent-streams
6431no option independent-streams
6432 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6434 yes | yes | yes | yes
6435 Arguments : none
6436
6437 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6438 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6439 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6440 receive data or not.
6441
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006442 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006443 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6444 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6445 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6446 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6447 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6448 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6449 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6450 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6451 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6452 socket buffers.
6453
6454 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6455 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6456 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6457 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6458 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6459
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006460 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006461 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6462 deprecated.
6463
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006464 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006465
6466
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006467option ldap-check
6468 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6470 yes | no | yes | yes
6471 Arguments : none
6472
6473 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6474 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6475 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6476 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6477
6478 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6479 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6480
6481 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6482 configure it.
6483
6484 Example :
6485 option ldap-check
6486
6487 See also : "option httpchk"
6488
6489
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006490option external-check
6491 Use external processes for server health checks
6492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6493 yes | no | yes | yes
6494
6495 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6496 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6497 command".
6498
6499 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6500
6501 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6502
6503
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006504option log-health-checks
6505no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006506 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6508 yes | no | yes | yes
6509 Arguments : none
6510
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006511 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6512 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6513 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006514
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006515 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6516 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6517 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6518 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6519 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6520
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006521 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006522 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006523
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006524 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6525 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6526 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006527
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006528
6529option log-separate-errors
6530no option log-separate-errors
6531 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6533 yes | yes | yes | no
6534 Arguments : none
6535
6536 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6537 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6538 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6539 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6540 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6541 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6542 provides very important information.
6543
6544 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6545 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6546 error logs.
6547
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006548 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006549 logging.
6550
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006551
6552option logasap
6553no option logasap
6554 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6556 yes | yes | yes | no
6557 Arguments : none
6558
6559 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6560 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6561 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6562 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6563 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6564 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6565 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006566 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006567 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6568 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6569
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006570 Examples :
6571 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6572 mode http
6573 option httplog
6574 option logasap
6575 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6576
6577 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6578 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6579 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6580 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6581
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006582 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006583 logging.
6584
6585
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006586option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006587 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6589 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006590 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006591 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6592 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006593 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006594
6595 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6596 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006597 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006598 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6599 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6600 in the MySQL table, like this :
6601
6602 USE mysql;
6603 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6604 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6605
6606 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006607 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006608 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6609 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6610 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6611 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6612 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6613 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6614 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6615
6616 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6617 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006618
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006619 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006620
6621 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6622 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6623 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6624 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006625 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6626 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006627
6628 See also: "option httpchk"
6629
6630
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006631option nolinger
6632no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006633 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006634 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6635 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006636 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006637
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006638 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006639 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6640 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6641 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6642 connections.
6643
6644 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6645 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6646 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6647 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6648 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6649 this too.
6650
6651 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6652 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6653 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6654
6655 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6656 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6657 for servers.
6658
6659 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6660 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6661
6662
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006663option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6664 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6666 yes | yes | yes | yes
6667 Arguments :
6668 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6669 matching <network>
6670 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6671 header name.
6672
6673 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6674 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6675 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6676 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6677 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6678 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6679 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6680 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6681 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6682 possible that the client has already brought one.
6683
6684 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6685 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6686 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6687 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6688 header and requires different one.
6689
6690 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6691 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6692 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6693 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6694 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6695 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6696 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6697
6698 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6699 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6700 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6701 both are defined.
6702
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006703 Examples :
6704 # Original Destination address
6705 frontend www
6706 mode http
6707 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6708
6709 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6710 backend www
6711 mode http
6712 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6713
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006714 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006715
6716
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006717option persist
6718no option persist
6719 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6720 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6721 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006722 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006723
6724 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6725 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6726 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6727 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6728 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6729 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6730 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6731 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6732 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6733 redirected to another valid server.
6734
6735 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6736 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6737
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006738 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006739
6740
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006741option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6742 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6744 yes | no | yes | yes
6745 Arguments :
6746 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6747 PostgreSQL server.
6748
6749 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6750 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6751 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6752 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6753
6754 See also: "option httpchk"
6755
6756
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006757option prefer-last-server
6758no option prefer-last-server
6759 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6760 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6761 yes | no | yes | yes
6762 Arguments : none
6763
6764 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6765 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6766 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6767 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6768 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6769 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6770 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6771 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6772 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006773 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6774 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006775 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6776 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6777 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006778 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6779 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6780 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006781
6782 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6783 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6784
6785 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6786
6787
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006788option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006789option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006790no option redispatch
6791 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6792 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6793 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006794 Arguments :
6795 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6796 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6797 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006798 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006799 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006800 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006801 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6802 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6803 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6804
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006805
6806 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6807 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6808 be able to access the service anymore.
6809
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01006810 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
6811 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006812
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006813 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006814 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6815 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006816
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006817 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6818 "redisp" keywords.
6819
6820 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6821 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6822
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006823 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006824
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006825
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006826option redis-check
6827 Use redis health checks for server testing
6828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6829 yes | no | yes | yes
6830 Arguments : none
6831
6832 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6833 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6834 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6835 find the "+PONG" response message.
6836
6837 Example :
6838 option redis-check
6839
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006840 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006841
6842
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006843option smtpchk
6844option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6845 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6847 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006848 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006849 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02006850 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006851 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6852
6853 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6854 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6855 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6856
6857 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6858 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6859 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6860 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6861 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6862 dead server.
6863
6864 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6865 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006866 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006867 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6868
6869 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6870 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6871 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6872 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006873 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006874
6875 Example :
6876 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6877
6878 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6879
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006880
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006881option socket-stats
6882no option socket-stats
6883
6884 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6886 yes | yes | yes | no
6887
6888 Arguments : none
6889
6890
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006891option splice-auto
6892no option splice-auto
6893 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6895 yes | yes | yes | yes
6896 Arguments : none
6897
6898 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6899 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006900 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006901 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006902 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006903 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6904 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6905 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6906 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6907
6908 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6909 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6910 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6911 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6912 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6913 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6914 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6915 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6916 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6917 keyword.
6918
6919 Example :
6920 option splice-auto
6921
6922 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6923 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6924
6925 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6926 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6927
6928
6929option splice-request
6930no option splice-request
6931 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6933 yes | yes | yes | yes
6934 Arguments : none
6935
6936 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006937 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006938 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6939 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6940 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6941 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6942
6943 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6944
6945 Example :
6946 option splice-request
6947
6948 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6949 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6950
6951 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6952 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6953
6954
6955option splice-response
6956no option splice-response
6957 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6959 yes | yes | yes | yes
6960 Arguments : none
6961
6962 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006963 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006964 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6965 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6966 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6967 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6968
6969 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6970
6971 Example :
6972 option splice-response
6973
6974 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6975 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6976
6977 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6978 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6979
6980
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006981option spop-check
6982 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6984 no | no | no | yes
6985 Arguments : none
6986
6987 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6988 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6989 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6990 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6991
6992 Example :
6993 option spop-check
6994
6995 See also : "option httpchk"
6996
6997
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006998option srvtcpka
6999no option srvtcpka
7000 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7002 yes | no | yes | yes
7003 Arguments : none
7004
7005 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7006 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007007 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007008 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7009
7010 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7011 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7012 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7013 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7014
7015 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7016 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7017 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7018 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7019 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7020
7021 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7022
7023 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7024 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7025 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7026
7027 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7028 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7029
7030 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7031
7032
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007033option ssl-hello-chk
7034 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7036 yes | no | yes | yes
7037 Arguments : none
7038
7039 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7040 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7041 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7042 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7043 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7044 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7045 hello message.
7046
7047 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7048 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7049 messages, which is appreciable.
7050
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007051 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7052 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7053 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007054
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007055 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7056
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007057
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007058option tcp-check
7059 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7060 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7061 yes | no | yes | yes
7062
7063 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7064 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7065
7066 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7067 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7068 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7069
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007070 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007071 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7072 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7073 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7074 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7075 only.
7076
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007077 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007078 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7079 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7080 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7081 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7082
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007083 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007084 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7085 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007086 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007087 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7088 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7089 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7090 the respective protocols.
7091 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007092 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007093
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007094 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7095 script.
7096
7097 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7098 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7099 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7100 The "comment" is of course optional.
7101
7102
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007103 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007104 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007105 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007106 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007107
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007108 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007109 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007110 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007111
7112 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7113 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007114 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007115 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007116 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007117 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007118 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007119 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007120 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7121 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007122 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007123 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7124 tcp-check expect string +OK
7125
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007126 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007127 (send many headers before analyzing)
7128 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007129 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007130 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7131 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7132 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7133 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007134 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007135
7136
7137 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7138
7139
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007140option tcp-smart-accept
7141no option tcp-smart-accept
7142 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7144 yes | yes | yes | no
7145 Arguments : none
7146
7147 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7148 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7149 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7150 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7151 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7152 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7153
7154 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7155 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7156 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7157 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7158
7159 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7160 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7161 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007162 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007163
7164 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7165 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7166 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7167
7168 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7169 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7170 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7171
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007172 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7173
7174
7175option tcp-smart-connect
7176no option tcp-smart-connect
7177 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7179 yes | no | yes | yes
7180 Arguments : none
7181
7182 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7183 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7184 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7185 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7186 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7187
7188 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7189 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7190 complex.
7191
7192 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7193 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7194 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7195
7196 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7197 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7198
7199 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7200
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007201
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007202option tcpka
7203 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7205 yes | yes | yes | yes
7206 Arguments : none
7207
7208 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7209 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007210 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007211 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7212
7213 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7214 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7215 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7216 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7217
7218 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7219 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7220 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7221 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7222 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7223
7224 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7225
7226 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7227 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7228 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7229 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7230 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7231 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7232 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7233 backends.
7234
7235 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7236
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007237
7238option tcplog
7239 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007241 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007242 Arguments : none
7243
7244 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7245 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7246 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7247 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7248 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7249 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7250 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7251 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7252
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007253 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7254
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007255 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007256
7257
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007258option transparent
7259no option transparent
7260 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007262 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007263 Arguments : none
7264
7265 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7266 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7267 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7268 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7269 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7270 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7271 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7272 appropriate server.
7273
7274 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7275 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7276
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007277 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007278 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007279
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007280
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007281external-check command <command>
7282 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7284 yes | no | yes | yes
7285
7286 Arguments :
7287 <command> is the external command to run
7288
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007289 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7290
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007291 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007292
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007293 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7294 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7295 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7296 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7297 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7298 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007299
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007300 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7301
7302 Environment variables :
7303 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7304 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7305
7306 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7307
7308 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7309
7310 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7311 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7312 for a UNIX socket).
7313
7314 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7315
7316 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7317
7318 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7319
7320 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7321
7322 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7323
7324 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7325 socket).
7326
7327 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7328 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7329
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007330 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7331 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7332 failed.
7333
7334 Example :
7335 external-check command /bin/true
7336
7337 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7338
7339
7340external-check path <path>
7341 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7343 yes | no | yes | yes
7344
7345 Arguments :
7346 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7347
7348 The default path is "".
7349
7350 Example :
7351 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7352
7353 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7354 "external-check command"
7355
7356
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007357persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007358persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007359 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7361 yes | no | yes | yes
7362 Arguments :
7363 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007364 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7365 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007366
7367 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7368 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007369 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007370 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7371 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7372 forwarded to this server.
7373
7374 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7375 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7376 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007377 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007378 a single "listen" section.
7379
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007380 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7381 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7382 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7383
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007384 Example :
7385 listen tse-farm
7386 bind :3389
7387 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7388 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7389 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7390 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7391 persist rdp-cookie
7392 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007393 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007394 balance rdp-cookie
7395 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7396 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7397
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007398 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7399 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007400
7401
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007402rate-limit sessions <rate>
7403 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7405 yes | yes | yes | no
7406 Arguments :
7407 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7408 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7409
7410 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7411 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7412 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7413 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7414 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7415 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7416
7417 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7418 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7419 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7420 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7421
7422 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7423 listen smtp
7424 mode tcp
7425 bind :25
7426 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007427 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007428
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007429 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7430 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7431 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007432
7433 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7434
7435
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007436redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7437redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7438redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007439 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7441 no | yes | yes | yes
7442
7443 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007444 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007445
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007446 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007447 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007448 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7449 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7450 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007451
7452 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7453 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7454 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7455 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7456 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007457 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7458 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7459 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7460 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007461
7462 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7463 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7464 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7465 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7466 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7467 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007468 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007469 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007470 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7471 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7472 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007473
7474 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007475 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7476 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7477 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007478 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007479 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7480 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7481 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7482 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007483
7484 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007485 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007486
7487 - "drop-query"
7488 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7489 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7490 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7491 with a location-type redirect.
7492
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007493 - "append-slash"
7494 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7495 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7496 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7497 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7498
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007499 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7500 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7501 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7502 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7503 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7504 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7505 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7506
7507 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7508 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7509 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7510 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7511 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7512 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7513 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007514
7515 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7516 acl clear dst_port 80
7517 acl secure dst_port 8080
7518 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007519 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007520 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007521 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7522
7523 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007524 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7525 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7526 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007527 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007528
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007529 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7530 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7531 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7532
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007533 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007534 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007535
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007536 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007537 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7538 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7539 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007540
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007541 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007542
7543
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007544redisp (deprecated)
7545redispatch (deprecated)
7546 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7547 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7548 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007549 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007550
7551 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7552 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7553 be able to access the service anymore.
7554
7555 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7556 redistribute them to a working server.
7557
7558 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7559 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7560 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007561
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007562 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7563 "option redispatch" instead.
7564
7565 See also : "option redispatch"
7566
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007567
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007568reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007569 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7571 no | yes | yes | yes
7572 Arguments :
7573 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7574 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007575 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007576
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007577 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7578 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7579
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007580 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7581 the last header of an HTTP request.
7582
7583 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7584 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7585 responses.
7586
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007587 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7588 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7589 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7590
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007591 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7592 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007593
7594
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007595reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7596reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007597 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7599 no | yes | yes | yes
7600 Arguments :
7601 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7602 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7603 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7604 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7605 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7606 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7607 ignores case.
7608
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007609 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7610 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7611
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007612 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7613 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7614 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7615 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007616 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007617
7618 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7619 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7620
7621 Example :
7622 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7623 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7624 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7625
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007626 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7627 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007628
7629
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007630reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7631reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007632 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7634 no | yes | yes | yes
7635 Arguments :
7636 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7637 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7638 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7639 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7640 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7641 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7642
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007643 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7644 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7645
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007646 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7647 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7648 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7649 next servers.
7650
7651 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7652 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7653 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7654
7655 Example :
7656 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7657 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7658 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7659
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007660 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7661 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007662
7663
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007664reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7665reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007666 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7668 no | yes | yes | yes
7669 Arguments :
7670 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7671 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7672 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7673 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7674 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7675 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7676 case.
7677
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007678 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7679 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7680
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007681 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7682 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7683 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7684 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007685 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007686
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007687 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007688 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007689 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007690
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007691 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7692 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7693
7694 Example :
7695 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7696 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7697 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7698
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007699 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7700 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007701
7702
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007703reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7704reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007705 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7707 no | yes | yes | yes
7708 Arguments :
7709 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7710 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7711 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7712 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7713 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7714 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7715 case.
7716
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007717 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7718 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7719
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007720 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7721 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7722 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7723 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7724
7725 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7726 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7727
7728 Example :
7729 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7730 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7731 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7732 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7733
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007734 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7735 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007736
7737
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007738reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7739reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007740 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7742 no | yes | yes | yes
7743 Arguments :
7744 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7745 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7746 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7747 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7748 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7749 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7750
7751 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7752 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7753 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7754 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007755 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007756
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007757 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7758 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7759
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007760 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7761 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7762 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7763
7764 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7765 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7766 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7767 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7768 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7769
7770 Example :
7771 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007772 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007773 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7774 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7775
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007776 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7777 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007778
7779
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007780reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7781reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007782 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7784 no | yes | yes | yes
7785 Arguments :
7786 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7787 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7788 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7789 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7790 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7791 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7792 ignores case.
7793
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007794 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7795 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7796
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007797 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7798 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007799 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7800 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7801 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007802 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7803 not set.
7804
7805 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7806 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7807 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7808 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7809 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7810
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007811 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007812 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007813 # block all others.
7814 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7815 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7816
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007817 # block bad guys
7818 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7819 reqitarpit . if badguys
7820
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007821 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7822 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007823
7824
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007825retries <value>
7826 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7827 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7828 yes | no | yes | yes
7829 Arguments :
7830 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7831 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7832 default value is 3.
7833
7834 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7835 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7836 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7837
7838 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007839 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7840 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007841
7842 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7843 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7844
7845 See also : "option redispatch"
7846
7847
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007848rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007849 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7851 no | yes | yes | yes
7852 Arguments :
7853 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7854 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007855 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007856
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007857 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7858 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7859
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007860 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7861 the last header of an HTTP response.
7862
7863 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7864 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7865 responses.
7866
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007867 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7868 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007869
7870
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007871rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7872rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007873 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7875 no | yes | yes | yes
7876 Arguments :
7877 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7878 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7879 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7880 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7881 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7882 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7883 ignores case.
7884
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007885 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7886 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7887
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007888 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7889 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007890 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007891 client.
7892
7893 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7894 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7895 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7896
7897 Example :
7898 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007899 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007900
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007901 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7902 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007903
7904
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007905rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7906rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007907 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7909 no | yes | yes | yes
7910 Arguments :
7911 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7912 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7913 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7914 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7915 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7916 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7917 ignores case.
7918
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007919 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7920 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7921
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007922 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7923 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7924 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7925 case-sensitive.
7926
7927 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007928 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7929 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7930 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007931
7932 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7933 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7934
7935 Example :
7936 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7937 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7938
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007939 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7940 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007941
7942
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007943rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7944rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007945 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7947 no | yes | yes | yes
7948 Arguments :
7949 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7950 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7951 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7952 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7953 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7954 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7955 ignores case.
7956
7957 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7958 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7959 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7960 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007961 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007962
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007963 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7964 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7965
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007966 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7967 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7968 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7969
7970 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7971 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7972 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7973 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7974 are not case-sensitive.
7975
7976 Example :
7977 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7978 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7979
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007980 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7981 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007982
7983
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007984server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007985 Declare a server in a backend
7986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7987 no | no | yes | yes
7988 Arguments :
7989 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007990 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007991 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007992
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007993 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7994 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7995 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7996 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007997 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7998 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7999 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8000 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8001 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008002 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8003 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8004 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8005 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8006 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8007 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8008 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008009 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008010 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8011 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8012 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8013 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8014 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8015 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008016 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8017 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008018 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8019 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008020
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008021 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008022 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8023 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8024 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8025 adding this value to the client's port.
8026
8027 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8028 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008029 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008030
8031 Examples :
8032 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8033 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008034 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008035 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8036 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8037 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008038
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008039 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8040 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8041 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8042 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8043 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8044
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008045 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8046 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008047
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008048server-state-file-name [<file>]
8049 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8050 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8051 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8052 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8053 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8054 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8055
8056 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8057 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8058
8059 global
8060 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8061
8062 backend bk
8063 load-server-state-from-file
8064
8065 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8066 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008067
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008068server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8069 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8070 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8072 no | no | yes | yes
8073
8074 Arguments:
8075 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8076
8077 <num | range>
8078 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8079 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8080 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8081 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8082
8083 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8084
8085 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8086
8087 <params*>
8088 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8089 keyword.
8090
8091 Examples:
8092 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8093 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8094 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8095
8096 # or
8097 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8098
8099 # would be equivalent to:
8100 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8101 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8102 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8103
8104
8105
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008106source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008107source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008108source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008109 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8111 yes | no | yes | yes
8112 Arguments :
8113 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8114 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008115
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008116 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008117 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8118 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8119 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8120 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8121 supported prefixes are :
8122 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8123 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8124 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008125 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008126 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8127 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008128
8129 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8130 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008131 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8132 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8133 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008134
8135 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8136 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8137 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8138 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8139 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8140 <addr>.
8141
8142 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8143 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8144 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8145 port.
8146
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008147 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8148 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8149 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8150 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008151 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008152 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8153 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8154 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8155 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8156 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8157 HTTP header.
8158
8159 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8160 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008161 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008162 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8163 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8164 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8165 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8166 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8167 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8168 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8169
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008170 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8171 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8172 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8173 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8174 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8175 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8176
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008177 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8178 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8179 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8180 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8181
8182 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8183 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8184 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8185 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8186 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8187 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8188
8189 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8190 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8191 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8192 there are two methods :
8193
8194 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8195 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8196 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8197 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8198 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8199 of the client ranges may be used.
8200
8201 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8202 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8203 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8204 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8205 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8206 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8207 same session.
8208
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008209 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8210 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8211 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008212 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008213
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008214 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8215
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008216 Examples :
8217 backend private
8218 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8219 source 192.168.1.200
8220
8221 backend transparent_ssl1
8222 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8223 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8224
8225 backend transparent_ssl2
8226 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8227 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8228 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8229
8230 backend transparent_ssl3
8231 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8232 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8233 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8234
8235 backend transparent_smtp
8236 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8237 # with Tproxy version 4.
8238 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8239
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008240 backend transparent_http
8241 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8242 # proxy.
8243 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8244
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008245 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008246 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8247
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008248
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008249srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8250 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8252 yes | no | yes | yes
8253 Arguments :
8254 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8255 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8256 as explained at the top of this document.
8257
8258 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8259 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8260 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8261 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8262 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8263 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8264 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8265
8266 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8267 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8268 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8269 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8270 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008271 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008272 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008273 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008274
8275 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8276 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8277 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8278 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8279 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8280 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8281
8282 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8283 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8284
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008285 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8286 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008287
8288
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008289stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8290 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008292 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008293
8294 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8295 matched.
8296
8297 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8298 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8299
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008300 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8301 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008302 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008303
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008304 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8305 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8306 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8307 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008308
8309 Example :
8310 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8311 backend stats_localhost
8312 stats enable
8313 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8314
8315 Example :
8316 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8317 backend stats_auth
8318 stats enable
8319 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8320 stats admin if TRUE
8321
8322 Example :
8323 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8324 userlist stats-auth
8325 group admin users admin
8326 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8327 group readonly users haproxy
8328 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8329
8330 backend stats_auth
8331 stats enable
8332 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8333 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8334 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8335 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8336
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008337 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8338 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8339 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008340
8341
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008342stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8343 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008345 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008346 Arguments :
8347 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8348
8349 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8350
8351 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8352 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8353 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8354 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8355 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8356 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8357
8358 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8359 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8360 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008361 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008362
8363 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8364 report using "stats scope".
8365
8366 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8367 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8368 unobvious parameters.
8369
8370 Example :
8371 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8372 backend public_www
8373 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8374 stats enable
8375 stats hide-version
8376 stats scope .
8377 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008378 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008379 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8380 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8381
8382 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8383 backend private_monitoring
8384 stats enable
8385 stats uri /admin?stats
8386 stats refresh 5s
8387
8388 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8389
8390
8391stats enable
8392 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008394 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008395 Arguments : none
8396
8397 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8398 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8399 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8400 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8401 - stats auth : no authentication
8402 - stats scope : no restriction
8403
8404 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8405 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8406 unobvious parameters.
8407
8408 Example :
8409 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8410 backend public_www
8411 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8412 stats enable
8413 stats hide-version
8414 stats scope .
8415 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008416 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008417 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8418 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8419
8420 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8421 backend private_monitoring
8422 stats enable
8423 stats uri /admin?stats
8424 stats refresh 5s
8425
8426 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8427
8428
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008429stats hide-version
8430 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008432 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008433 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008434
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008435 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8436 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8437 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8438 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8439 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8440 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008441
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008442 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8443 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8444 unobvious parameters.
8445
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008446 Example :
8447 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8448 backend public_www
8449 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008450 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008451 stats hide-version
8452 stats scope .
8453 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008454 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008455 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8456 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008457
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008458 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8459 backend private_monitoring
8460 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008461 stats uri /admin?stats
8462 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008463
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008464 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008465
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008466
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008467stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8468 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8469 Access control for statistics
8470
8471 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8472 no | no | yes | yes
8473
8474 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8475 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8476 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8477 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8478 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8479 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8480
8481 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8482 instance.
8483
8484 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8485 about ACL usage.
8486
8487
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008488stats realm <realm>
8489 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008491 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008492 Arguments :
8493 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8494 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8495 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8496
8497 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8498 using a backslash ('\').
8499
8500 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8501 only related to authentication.
8502
8503 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8504 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8505 unobvious parameters.
8506
8507 Example :
8508 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8509 backend public_www
8510 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8511 stats enable
8512 stats hide-version
8513 stats scope .
8514 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008515 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008516 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8517 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8518
8519 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8520 backend private_monitoring
8521 stats enable
8522 stats uri /admin?stats
8523 stats refresh 5s
8524
8525 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8526
8527
8528stats refresh <delay>
8529 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008531 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008532 Arguments :
8533 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8534 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8535 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8536 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8537 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8538 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8539
8540 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8541 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8542 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8543 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8544
8545 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8546 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8547 unobvious parameters.
8548
8549 Example :
8550 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8551 backend public_www
8552 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8553 stats enable
8554 stats hide-version
8555 stats scope .
8556 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008557 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008558 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8559 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8560
8561 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8562 backend private_monitoring
8563 stats enable
8564 stats uri /admin?stats
8565 stats refresh 5s
8566
8567 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8568
8569
8570stats scope { <name> | "." }
8571 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008573 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008574 Arguments :
8575 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8576 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8577 section in which the statement appears.
8578
8579 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8580 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8581 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8582 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8583 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8584 exists.
8585
8586 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8587 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8588 unobvious parameters.
8589
8590 Example :
8591 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8592 backend public_www
8593 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8594 stats enable
8595 stats hide-version
8596 stats scope .
8597 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008598 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008599 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8600 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8601
8602 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8603 backend private_monitoring
8604 stats enable
8605 stats uri /admin?stats
8606 stats refresh 5s
8607
8608 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8609
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008610
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008611stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008612 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008614 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008615
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008616 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008617 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8618
8619 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8620 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8621
8622 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8623 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008624 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008625
8626 Example :
8627 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8628 backend private_monitoring
8629 stats enable
8630 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8631 stats uri /admin?stats
8632 stats refresh 5s
8633
8634 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8635 global section.
8636
8637
8638stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008639 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8641 yes | yes | yes | yes
8642 Arguments : none
8643
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008644 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008645 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8646 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8647 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8648 - IP (socket, server)
8649 - cookie (backend, server)
8650
8651 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8652 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008653 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008654
8655 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8656
8657
8658stats show-node [ <name> ]
8659 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008661 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008662 Arguments:
8663 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8664 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8665
8666 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8667 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008668 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008669
8670 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8671 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8672 unobvious parameters.
8673
8674 Example:
8675 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8676 backend private_monitoring
8677 stats enable
8678 stats show-node Europe-1
8679 stats uri /admin?stats
8680 stats refresh 5s
8681
8682 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8683 section.
8684
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008685
8686stats uri <prefix>
8687 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008689 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008690 Arguments :
8691 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8692 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8693 query string.
8694
8695 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8696 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8697 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8698 possible to reach it in the application.
8699
8700 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008701 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008702 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8703 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8704 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8705 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8706
8707 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8708 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8709 an address or a port to statistics only.
8710
8711 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8712 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8713 unobvious parameters.
8714
8715 Example :
8716 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8717 backend public_www
8718 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8719 stats enable
8720 stats hide-version
8721 stats scope .
8722 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008723 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008724 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8725 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8726
8727 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8728 backend private_monitoring
8729 stats enable
8730 stats uri /admin?stats
8731 stats refresh 5s
8732
8733 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8734
8735
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008736stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8737 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008739 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008740
8741 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008742 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008743 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008744 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008745 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8746
8747 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8748 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8749 the "stick-table" statement.
8750
8751 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8752 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8753 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8754 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8755 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8756
8757 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8758 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8759 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8760 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8761 transformation rules.
8762
8763 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8764 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8765 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8766 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8767 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8768 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8769 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8770
8771 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8772 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8773 ACL based conditions.
8774
8775 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8776 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8777 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8778 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8779
8780 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8781 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8782 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8783 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8784
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008785 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8786 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008787 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008788
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008789 Example :
8790 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8791 # last 30 minutes
8792 backend pop
8793 mode tcp
8794 balance roundrobin
8795 stick store-request src
8796 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8797 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8798 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8799
8800 backend smtp
8801 mode tcp
8802 balance roundrobin
8803 stick match src table pop
8804 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8805 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8806
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008807 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008808 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008809
8810
8811stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8812 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8814 no | no | yes | yes
8815
8816 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8817 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8818 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8819 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8820
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008821 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8822 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008823 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008824
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008825 Examples :
8826 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008827 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008828
8829 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8830 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8831 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8832
8833
8834 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8835 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8836 backend http
8837 mode http
8838 balance roundrobin
8839 stick on src table https
8840 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8841 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8842 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8843
8844 backend https
8845 mode tcp
8846 balance roundrobin
8847 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8848 stick on src
8849 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8850 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8851
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008852 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008853
8854
8855stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8856 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8858 no | no | yes | yes
8859
8860 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008861 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008862 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008863 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008864 server is selected.
8865
8866 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8867 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8868 the "stick-table" statement.
8869
8870 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8871 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8872 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8873 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8874 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8875 address.
8876
8877 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8878 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8879 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8880 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8881 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8882 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8883 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8884 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8885 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8886 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8887
8888 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8889 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8890 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8891 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8892 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8893 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8894 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8895
8896 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8897 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8898 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8899 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8900
8901 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8902 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8903 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8904 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8905 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8906 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008907 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8908 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8909 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8910 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8911 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8912 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008913
8914 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8915 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8916 the request.
8917
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008918 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8919 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008920 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008921
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008922 Example :
8923 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8924 # last 30 minutes
8925 backend pop
8926 mode tcp
8927 balance roundrobin
8928 stick store-request src
8929 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8930 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8931 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8932
8933 backend smtp
8934 mode tcp
8935 balance roundrobin
8936 stick match src table pop
8937 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8938 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8939
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008940 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008941 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008942
8943
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008944stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008945 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8946 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008947 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008949 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008950
8951 Arguments :
8952 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8953 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8954 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8955 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8956
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008957 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8958 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8959 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8960 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8961
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008962 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8963 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8964 instance.
8965
8966 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8967 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8968 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8969 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8970 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8971 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008972 to 32 characters.
8973
8974 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8975 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8976 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008977 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008978 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8979 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008980
8981 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008982 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8983 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008984 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8985 increase.
8986
8987 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008988 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8989 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8990 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008991
8992 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8993 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8994 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8995 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008996 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008997 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8998 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8999 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9000 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9001 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9002 parameter (see below).
9003
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009004 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9005 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9006 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9007 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9008 soft restart.
9009
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009010 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9011 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009012
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009013 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9014 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9015 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9016 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009017 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009018 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009019 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9020 if not expiration delay is specified.
9021
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009022 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9023 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9024 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9025 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009026 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9027 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9028 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9029 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9030 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9031 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9032 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9033 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9034 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9035 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9036 types and their arguments.
9037
9038 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9039 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9040 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9041 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9042
9043 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9044 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9045 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009046 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009047
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009048 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9049 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9050 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009051 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009052 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009053 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009054
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009055 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9056 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9057 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9058 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9059
9060 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9061 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9062 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9063 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9064 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9065 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9066
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009067 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9068 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9069 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9070 they were received.
9071
9072 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9073 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9074 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9075 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9076 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9077
9078 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9079 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9080 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9081 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9082 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9083
9084 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9085 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9086 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9087
9088 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9089 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9090 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9091 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9092 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9093
9094 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9095 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9096 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9097 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9098 the client side.
9099
9100 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9101 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9102 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9103 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9104 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9105 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9106 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9107
9108 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9109 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9110 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9111 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9112 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9113 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009114 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009115
9116 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9117 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9118 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9119 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9120 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9121 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9122
9123 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009124 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009125 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9126 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9127
9128 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9129 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9130 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9131 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9132 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9133 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9134 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9135 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9136 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9137 recommended for better fairness.
9138
9139 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009140 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009141 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9142 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9143
9144 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9145 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9146 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9147 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9148 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9149 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9150 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9151 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9152 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9153 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009154
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009155 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9156 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009157 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9158 reference it.
9159
9160 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9161 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009162 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9163 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9164 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009165
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009166 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9167 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9168 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9169 something that can be ignored.
9170
9171 Example:
9172 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9173 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9174 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9175 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9176
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009177 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009178 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009179
9180
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009181stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009182 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9184 no | no | yes | yes
9185
9186 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009187 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009188 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009189 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009190 server is selected.
9191
9192 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9193 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9194 the "stick-table" statement.
9195
9196 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9197 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9198 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9199 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9200
9201 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9202 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9203 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9204 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9205 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9206 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009207 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009208 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9209 rules.
9210
9211 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9212 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9213 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9214 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9215 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9216 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9217 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9218
9219 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9220 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9221 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9222 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9223
9224 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9225 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9226 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9227 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9228 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9229 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009230 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9231 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9232 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9233 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9234 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9235 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9236 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9237 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9238 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009239
9240 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9241
9242 Example :
9243 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9244 backend https
9245 mode tcp
9246 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009247 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009248 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009249
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009250 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9251 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9252
9253 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9254 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9255 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9256
9257 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9258 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009259
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009260 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9261 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9262 # at offset 44.
9263
9264 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9265 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9266
9267 # Learn on response if server hello.
9268 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009269
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009270 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9271 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9272
9273 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9274 extraction.
9275
9276
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009277tcp-check connect [params*]
9278 Opens a new connection
9279 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9280 no | no | yes | yes
9281
9282 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9283 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9284 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9285
9286 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9287 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9288 of the sequence.
9289
9290 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9291 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9292 do.
9293
9294 Parameters :
9295 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9296 use the TCP connection.
9297
9298 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9299 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9300 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9301
9302 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9303
9304 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9305
9306 Examples:
9307 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9308 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9309 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9310 option tcp-check
9311 tcp-check connect
9312 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9313 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9314 tcp-check send \r\n
9315 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9316 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9317 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9318 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9319 tcp-check send \r\n
9320 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9321 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9322
9323 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9324 option tcp-check
9325 tcp-check connect port 110
9326 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9327 tcp-check connect port 143
9328 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9329 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9330
9331 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9332
9333
9334tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009335 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009336 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9337 no | no | yes | yes
9338
9339 Arguments :
9340 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9341 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9342 binary.
9343 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9344 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9345 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9346
9347 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9348 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9349 with the usual backslash ('\').
9350 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009351 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009352 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9353 used upper or lower case.
9354
9355
9356 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9357
9358 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9359 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9360 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9361 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9362 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9363 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9364 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9365 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9366
9367 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9368 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9369 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9370 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9371 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9372 expression.
9373
9374 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9375 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9376 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9377 this exact hexadecimal string.
9378 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9379
9380 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9381 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9382 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9383 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9384 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9385 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9386 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9387 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9388 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9389 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9390 the null character.
9391
9392 Examples :
9393 # perform a POP check
9394 option tcp-check
9395 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9396
9397 # perform an IMAP check
9398 option tcp-check
9399 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9400
9401 # look for the redis master server
9402 option tcp-check
9403 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009404 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009405 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9406 tcp-check expect string role:master
9407 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9408 tcp-check expect string +OK
9409
9410
9411 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9412 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9413
9414
9415tcp-check send <data>
9416 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9417 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9418 no | no | yes | yes
9419
9420 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9421 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9422
9423 Examples :
9424 # look for the redis master server
9425 option tcp-check
9426 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9427 tcp-check expect string role:master
9428
9429 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9430 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9431
9432
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009433tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9434 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009435 tcp health check
9436 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9437 no | no | yes | yes
9438
9439 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9440 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009441 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009442 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9443 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9444 hexadecimal string.
9445 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9446
9447 Examples :
9448 # redis check in binary
9449 option tcp-check
9450 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9451 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9452
9453
9454 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9455 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9456
9457
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009458tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9459 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9461 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009462 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009463 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9464 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009465
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009466 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009467
9468 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9469 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009470 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9471 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9472 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9473 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9474 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9475 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009476
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009477 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9478 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9479 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9480 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009481
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009482 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009483 - accept :
9484 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9485 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9486 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009487
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009488 - reject :
9489 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9490 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9491 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9492 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9493 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9494 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9495 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9496 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9497 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9498 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9499 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009500 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009501
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009502 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9503 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9504 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9505 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9506 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9507 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9508 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9509 hosts.
9510
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009511 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9512 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9513 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9514 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9515 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9516 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9517 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9518 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9519
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009520 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9521 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9522 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9523 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9524 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9525 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9526 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9527 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9528 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009529 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9530 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009531
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009532 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009533 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009534 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9535 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9536 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9537 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9538 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9539 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9540 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9541 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9542 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9543 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9544 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9545 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009546
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009547 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009548 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009549 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009550 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009551 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9552 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9553 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009554
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009555 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9556 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9557 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9558 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009559
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009560 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9561 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9562 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9563 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9564 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009565 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9566 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9567 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9568 layer7 information is extracted.
9569
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009570 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9571 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9572 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9573 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9574 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009575
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009576 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9577 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9578 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9579 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9580
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009581 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9582 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9583 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9584 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9585
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009586 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9587 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9588 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9589 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9590 continues.
9591
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009592 - set-src <expr> :
9593 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9594 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9595 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009596 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009597
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009598 Arguments:
9599 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9600 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009601
9602 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009603 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9604
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009605 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9606 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009607
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009608 - set-src-port <expr> :
9609 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9610 expression.
9611
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009612 Arguments:
9613 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9614 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009615
9616 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009617 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9618
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009619 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9620 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9621 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009622
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009623 - set-dst <expr> :
9624 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9625 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9626 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9627 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9628 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9629
9630 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9631 followed by some converters.
9632
9633 Example:
9634
9635 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9636 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9637
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009638 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9639 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9640
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009641 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9642 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9643 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9644 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9645
9646
9647 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9648 followed by some converters.
9649
9650 Example:
9651
9652 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9653
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009654 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9655 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9656 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9657
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009658 - "silent-drop" :
9659 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009660 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009661 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9662 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9663 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9664 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9665 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009666 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9667 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009668 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9669 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009670 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009671 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9672 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9673 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9674 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9675
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009676 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9677 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9678 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009679
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009680 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9681 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9682 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009683
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009684 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009685 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009686 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009687
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009688 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9689 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9690 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009691
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009692 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009693 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9694 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009695
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009696 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9697
9698 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9699
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009700 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9701
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009702 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009703
9704
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009705tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9706 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009708 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009709 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009710 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9711 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009712
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009713 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009714
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009715 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009716 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9717 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9718 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9719 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009720
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009721 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9722 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9723 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9724 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009725 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9726 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9727 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9728 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9729 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9730 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009731 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009732 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009733
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009734 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9735 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9736 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9737 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009738
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009739 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009740 - accept : the request is accepted
9741 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9742 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009743 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009744 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009745 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009746 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009747 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009748 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009749 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009750 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009751 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009752
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009753 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9754 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009755
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009756 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9757 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9758 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9759 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9760 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9761 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009762
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009763 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009764 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9765 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009766
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009767 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009768 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9769 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9770 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9771 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009772 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9773 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9774 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009775
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009776 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009777 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9778 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9779 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009780
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009781 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009782 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9783 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009784
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009785 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9786 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009787 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009788 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9789 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009790 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009791 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009792 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009793 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9794 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009795 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009796 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9797 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009798
9799 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9800 followed by some converters.
9801
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009802 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9803 <var-name>.
9804
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009805 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9806 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9807 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9808 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9809 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9810
9811 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9812 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9813 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9814 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9815 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9816 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9817 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9818 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9819 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9820 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9821 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9822
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009823 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9824 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9825 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9826 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9827 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9828
9829 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9830
9831 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9832
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009833 Example:
9834
9835 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009836 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009837
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009838 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009839 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9840 # and reject everything else.
9841 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9842 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009843 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009844 tcp-request content reject
9845
9846 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009847 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9848 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9849 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009850 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009851
9852 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9853 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9854 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009855 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009856 tcp-request content reject
9857
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009858 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009859 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009860 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009861 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009862 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9863 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009864
9865 Example:
9866 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9867 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009868 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009869
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009870 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009871 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009872
9873 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009874 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009875 # protecting all our sites
9876 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009877 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9878 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009879 ...
9880 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9881
9882 backend http_dynamic
9883 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009884 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009885 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009886 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009887 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009888 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009889 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009890
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009891 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009892
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009893 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9894 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009895
9896
9897tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9898 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009900 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009901 Arguments :
9902 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9903 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9904 as explained at the top of this document.
9905
9906 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9907 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9908 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9909 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9910 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9911
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009912 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9913 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9914 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9915 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9916
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009917 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9918 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009919 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009920 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009921 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9922 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9923 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9924 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009925
9926 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9927 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9928 it pass through unaffected.
9929
9930 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9931 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9932 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009933 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009934 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9935 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009936 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9937 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9938 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009939
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009940 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009941 "timeout client".
9942
9943
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009944tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9945 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9947 no | no | yes | yes
9948 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009949 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9950 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009951
9952 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9953
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009954 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009955 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9956 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009957 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9958 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009959
9960 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9961
9962 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9963 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9964 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9965 inserted.
9966
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009967 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009968 - accept :
9969 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9970 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9971 the rules evaluation.
9972
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009973 - close :
9974 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9975 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9976 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9977 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9978 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9979 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009980 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009981 protocols.
9982
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009983 - reject :
9984 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9985 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009986 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009987
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009988 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9989 Sets a variable.
9990
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009991 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9992 Unsets a variable.
9993
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009994 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9995 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9996 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9997 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9998
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009999 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10000 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10001 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10002 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10003
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010004 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10005 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10006 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10007 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10008 continues.
10009
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010010 - "silent-drop" :
10011 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010012 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010013 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10014 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10015 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10016 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10017 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010018 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10019 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010020 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10021 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010022 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010023 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10024 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10025 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10026 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10027
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010028 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10029 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10030
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010031 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10032 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10033 for changing the default action to a reject.
10034
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010035 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10036 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10037 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10038 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010039 period.
10040
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010041 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10042 declared inline.
10043
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010044 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10045 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010046 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010047 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10048 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010049 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010050 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010051 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010052 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10053 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010054 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010055 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10056 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010057
10058 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10059 followed by some converters.
10060
10061 Example:
10062
10063 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10064
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010065 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10066 <var-name>.
10067
10068 Example:
10069
10070 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10071
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010072 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10073 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10074 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10075 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10076 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10077
10078 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10079
10080 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10081
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010082 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10083
10084 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10085
10086
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010087tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10088 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10090 no | yes | yes | no
10091 Arguments :
10092 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10093 below.
10094
10095 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10096
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010097 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010098 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10099 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10100 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10101 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10102 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10103 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10104 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010105 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010106 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10107 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10108 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10109 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10110 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10111 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10112 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10113 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10114 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10115 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10116 instead.
10117
10118 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10119 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10120 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10121 rules which may be inserted.
10122
10123 Several types of actions are supported :
10124 - accept : the request is accepted
10125 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10126 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10127 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010128 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010129 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10130 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010131 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010132 - silent-drop
10133
10134 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10135 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10136 sections for a complete description.
10137
10138 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10139 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10140 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10141
10142 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10143 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10144 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10145 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10146 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10147
10148 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10149 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10150
10151 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10152 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10153 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10154
10155 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10156 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10157 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10158
10159 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10160 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10161 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10162
10163 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10164 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10165 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10166
10167 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10168
10169 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10170
10171
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010172tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10173 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10175 no | no | yes | yes
10176 Arguments :
10177 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10178 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10179 as explained at the top of this document.
10180
10181 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10182
10183
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010184timeout check <timeout>
10185 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10186 established.
10187
10188 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10189 yes | no | yes | yes
10190 Arguments:
10191 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10192 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10193 as explained at the top of this document.
10194
10195 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10196 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010197 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010198 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010199 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10200 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10201 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010202
10203 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10204 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10205
10206 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10207 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010208 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010209
10210 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10211 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10212 forget about it.
10213
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010214 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10215 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010216
10217
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010218timeout client <timeout>
10219timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10220 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10222 yes | yes | yes | no
10223 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010224 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010225 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10226 as explained at the top of this document.
10227
10228 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10229 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10230 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010231 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10232 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10233 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10234 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010235 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10236 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10237 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010238 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010239 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010240 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10241 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010242 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10243 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010244
10245 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10246 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10247 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10248 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10249 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10250 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10251
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010252 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010253
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010254 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10255 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10256 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10257
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010258 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10259 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010260
10261
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010262timeout client-fin <timeout>
10263 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10265 yes | yes | yes | no
10266 Arguments :
10267 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10268 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10269 as explained at the top of this document.
10270
10271 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10272 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10273 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10274 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10275 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10276 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10277 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010278 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10279 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10280 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010281
10282 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10283 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10284 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10285
10286 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10287
10288
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010289timeout connect <timeout>
10290timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10291 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10293 yes | no | yes | yes
10294 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010295 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010296 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10297 as explained at the top of this document.
10298
10299 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010300 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010301 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010302 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010303 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10304 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010305
10306 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10307 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10308 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10309 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10310 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10311 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10312
10313 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10314 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10315 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10316
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010317 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10318 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010319
10320
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010321timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10322 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10324 yes | yes | yes | yes
10325 Arguments :
10326 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10327 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10328 as explained at the top of this document.
10329
10330 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10331 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10332 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10333 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10334 once the request has started to present itself.
10335
10336 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10337 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10338 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10339 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10340 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10341
10342 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10343 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10344 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10345 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10346
10347 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10348 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010349 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010350 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10351 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010352 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010353
10354 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10355 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10356 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10357 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10358
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010359 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10360 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010361 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10362
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010363 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10364
10365
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010366timeout http-request <timeout>
10367 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010369 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010370 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010371 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010372 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10373 as explained at the top of this document.
10374
10375 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10376 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10377 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10378 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10379 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10380 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10381 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010382 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10383 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10384 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10385 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010386 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010387 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10388 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010389
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010390 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10391 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10392 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10393 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10394 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010395 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010396
10397 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10398 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010399 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010400 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10401 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10402
10403 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010404 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10405 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10406 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010407
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010408 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010409 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010410
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010411
10412timeout queue <timeout>
10413 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10415 yes | no | yes | yes
10416 Arguments :
10417 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10418 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10419 as explained at the top of this document.
10420
10421 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10422 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10423 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10424 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10425 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10426
10427 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10428 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10429 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10430 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10431
10432 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10433
10434
10435timeout server <timeout>
10436timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10437 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10439 yes | no | yes | yes
10440 Arguments :
10441 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10442 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10443 as explained at the top of this document.
10444
10445 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10446 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10447 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10448 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10449 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10450 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10451 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10452
10453 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10454 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10455 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10456 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10457 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010458 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010459 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010460 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10461 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010462 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10463 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010464
10465 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10466 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10467 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10468 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10469 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10470 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10471
10472 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10473 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10474 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10475
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010476 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010477
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010478
10479timeout server-fin <timeout>
10480 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10482 yes | no | yes | yes
10483 Arguments :
10484 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10485 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10486 as explained at the top of this document.
10487
10488 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10489 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10490 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10491 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10492 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10493 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10494 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10495 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10496 situations, it should not be needed.
10497
10498 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10499 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10500 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10501
10502 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10503
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010504
10505timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010506 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10508 yes | yes | yes | yes
10509 Arguments :
10510 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10511 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10512 as explained at the top of this document.
10513
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010514 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10515 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10516 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10517 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010518
10519 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10520 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10521 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10522 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010523 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010524
10525 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10526
10527
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010528timeout tunnel <timeout>
10529 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10531 yes | no | yes | yes
10532 Arguments :
10533 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10534 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10535 as explained at the top of this document.
10536
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010537 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010538 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10539 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10540 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010541 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10542 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010543 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10544 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10545 specified.
10546
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010547 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10548 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10549 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10550 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10551 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10552 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10553 state.
10554
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010555 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10556 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10557 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10558 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010559 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010560
10561 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10562 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10563 forget about it.
10564
10565 Example :
10566 defaults http
10567 option http-server-close
10568 timeout connect 5s
10569 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010570 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010571 timeout server 30s
10572 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10573
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010574 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010575
10576
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010577transparent (deprecated)
10578 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010580 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010581 Arguments : none
10582
10583 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10584 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10585 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10586 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10587 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10588 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10589 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10590 appropriate server.
10591
10592 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10593
10594 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10595 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10596
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010597 See also: "option transparent"
10598
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010599unique-id-format <string>
10600 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10602 yes | yes | yes | no
10603 Arguments :
10604 <string> is a log-format string.
10605
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010606 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10607 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10608 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10609 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010610
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010611 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10612 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10613 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10614 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10615 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10616 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10617 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10618 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010619
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010620 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10621 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010622
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010623 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010624
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010625 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010626
10627 will generate:
10628
10629 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10630
10631 See also: "unique-id-header"
10632
10633unique-id-header <name>
10634 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10636 yes | yes | yes | no
10637 Arguments :
10638 <name> is the name of the header.
10639
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010640 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10641 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010642
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010643 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010644
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010645 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010646 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10647
10648 will generate:
10649
10650 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10651
10652 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010653
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010654use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010655 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10657 no | yes | yes | no
10658 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010659 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10660 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010661
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010662 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10663 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010664
10665 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10666 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10667 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010668 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010669 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010670 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10671 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010672
10673 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10674 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10675 assign the backend.
10676
10677 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10678 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10679 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10680 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10681 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10682 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10683
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010684 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010685 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010686 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10687 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10688 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10689
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010690 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10691 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10692 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10693 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10694 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10695 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10696 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10697 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10698 cannot be forced from the request.
10699
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010700 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010701 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10702 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10703
10704 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10705 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010706
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010707
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010708use-server <server> if <condition>
10709use-server <server> unless <condition>
10710 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10712 no | no | yes | yes
10713 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010714 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010715
10716 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10717
10718 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10719 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10720 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10721
10722 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10723 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10724 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10725 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10726 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10727 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10728 matches will assign the server.
10729
10730 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10731 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10732 with the next rules until one matches.
10733
10734 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10735 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10736 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10737 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10738
10739 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10740 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10741 stripped.
10742
10743 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10744 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10745 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10746 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10747
10748 Example :
10749 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10750 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10751 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10752 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10753 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10754 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010755 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010756 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10757 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10758
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010759 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010760
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010761
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100107625. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010763--------------------------
10764
10765The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10766depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10767settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10768written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10769described in this section.
10770
10771
107725.1. Bind options
10773-----------------
10774
10775The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10776as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10777no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10778parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10779while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10780provided immediately after the setting name.
10781
10782The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10783
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010784accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10785 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10786 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10787 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10788 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10789 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10790 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10791 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10792 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10793 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010794 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10795 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10796 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010797
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010798accept-proxy
10799 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010800 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10801 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010802 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10803 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10804 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10805 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010806 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010807 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10808 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010809 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10810 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010811
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010812allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010813 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010814 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
10815 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, ie requests
10816 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10817 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010818
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010819alpn <protocols>
10820 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10821 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10822 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10823 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10824 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010825 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10826 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10827 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10828 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10829 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10830 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10831 preference, like below :
10832
10833 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010834
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010835backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010836 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010837 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10838
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010839curves <curves>
10840 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10841 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10842 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10843 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10844 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10845 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10846
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010847ecdhe <named curve>
10848 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010849 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10850 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010851
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010852ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010853 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10854 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10855 client's certificate.
10856
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010857ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10858 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10859 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10860 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10861 error is ignored.
10862
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010863ca-sign-file <cafile>
10864 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10865 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10866 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10867 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10868 'generate-certificates' for details.
10869
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010870ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10872 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10873 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10874 'generate-certificates' for details.
10875
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010876ciphers <ciphers>
10877 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10878 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010879 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010880 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010881 information and recommendations see e.g.
10882 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10883 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10884 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10885
10886ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10887 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10888 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10889 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10890 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010891 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10892 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010893
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010894crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010895 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10896 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10897 to verify client's certificate.
10898
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010899crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010900 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10901 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10902 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10903 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10904 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10905 file.
10906
10907 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10908 are loaded.
10909
10910 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010911 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010912 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10913 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10914 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10915 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010916 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10917 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010918 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010919
10920 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10921 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10922 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10923 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010924 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10925 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010926
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010927 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010928
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010929 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010930 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010931 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10932 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010933 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10934 clients).
10935
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010936 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10937 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10938 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10939 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10940 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10941 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10942 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10943 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10944 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10945 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10946 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10947 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10948 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10949
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010950 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10951 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10952 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10953 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10954 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10955
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010956 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10957 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10958 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10959 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010960
10961 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10962 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10963 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10964 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10965 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10966 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10967 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10968 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10969 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10970
10971 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10972
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010973 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010974 a cert bundle.
10975
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010976 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010977 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10978 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10979 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10980 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10981 provide multi-cert support.
10982
10983 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10984
10985 Filename | CN | SAN
10986 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10987 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010988 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010989 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10990 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10991
10992 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10993 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10994 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10995 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010996 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10997 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10998 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010999
11000 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11001 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11002
11003 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11004 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11005 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11006
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011007crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011008 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011009 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011010 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011011 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011012
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011013crt-list <file>
11014 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011015 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11016 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011017
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011018 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11019
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011020 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11021 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011022 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011023 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011024
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011025 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11026 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11027 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11028 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11029 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11030 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11031 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11032 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011033
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011034 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011035 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011036 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11037 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11038 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011039
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011040 crt-list file example:
11041 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011042 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011043 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011044 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011045
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011046defer-accept
11047 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11048 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11049 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011050 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011051 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11052 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11053 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11054 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11055 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11056 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11057 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11058
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011059expose-fd listeners
11060 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11061 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011062 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11063 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011064 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011065
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011066force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011067 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011068 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011069 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011070 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011071
11072force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011073 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011074 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011075 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011076
11077force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011078 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011079 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011080 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011081
11082force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011083 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011084 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011085 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011086
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011087force-tlsv13
11088 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11089 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011090 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011091
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011092generate-certificates
11093 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11094 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11095 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11096 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11097 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11098 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11099 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11100 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11101 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11102 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11103 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11104
11105 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11106 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011107 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011108 certificate is used many times.
11109
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011110gid <gid>
11111 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11112 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11113 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11114 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11115 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11116
11117group <group>
11118 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11119 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11120 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11121 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11122 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11123
11124id <id>
11125 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11126 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11127 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11128 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11129
11130interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011131 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11132 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11133 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11134 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11135 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11136 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011137 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11138 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11139 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11140 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11141 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11142 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011143
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011144level <level>
11145 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11146 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11147 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011148 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011149 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11150 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11151 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011152 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011153 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011154 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011155 all counters).
11156
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011157severity-output <format>
11158 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11159 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11160 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11161 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11162 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11163 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11164 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11165 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11166 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11167 rfc5424 convention.
11168
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011169maxconn <maxconn>
11170 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11171 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11172 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11173 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11174 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11175 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11176 eat all memory.
11177
11178mode <mode>
11179 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11180 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11181 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11182 UNIX sockets.
11183
11184mss <maxseg>
11185 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11186 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11187 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11188 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11189 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11190 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11191 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11192 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11193 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11194 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11195 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11196
11197name <name>
11198 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11199 page.
11200
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011201namespace <name>
11202 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11203 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11204 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11205 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11206
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011207nice <nice>
11208 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11209 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11210 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11211 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11212 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11213 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11214 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11215 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11216 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11217 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11218 one for an RDP socket.
11219
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011220no-ca-names
11221 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11222 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11223
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011224no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011225 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011226 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011227 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011228 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011229 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11230 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011231
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011232no-tls-tickets
11233 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11234 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11235 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011236 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11237 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011238
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011239no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011240 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011241 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011242 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011243 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011244 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11245 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011246
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011247no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011248 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011249 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011250 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011251 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011252 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11253 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011254
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011255no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011256 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011257 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011258 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011259 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011260 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11261 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011262
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011263no-tlsv13
11264 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11265 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11266 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11267 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011268 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11269 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011270
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011271npn <protocols>
11272 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11273 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11274 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11275 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011276 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011277 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11278 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11279 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11280 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11281 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011282
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011283prefer-client-ciphers
11284 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11285 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11286 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011287 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11288 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11289 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011290
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011291process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011292 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011293 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011294 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011295 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11296 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11297 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11298 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011299 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011300 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11301 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11302 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11303 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11304 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011305
11306 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11307
11308 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11309 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11310 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11311 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11312 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11313 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11314 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11315 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011316
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011317proto <name>
11318 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11319 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11320 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11321 in haproxy -vv.
11322 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11323 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011324 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011325 h2" on the bind line.
11326
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011327ssl
11328 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011329 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011330 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11331 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011332 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11333 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011334
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011335ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11336 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11337 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11338 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11339
11340ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11341 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11342 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11343 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11344
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011345strict-sni
11346 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11347 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11348 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11349 See the "crt" option for more information.
11350
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011351tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011352 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011353 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11354 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011355 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011356 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11357 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11358 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11359 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11360 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11361 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11362 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11363
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011364tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011365 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011366 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11367 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11368 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11369 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11370 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11371 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11372 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011373 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11374 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11375 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011376
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011377tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11378 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011379 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11380 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11381 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11382 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11383 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11384 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11385 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11386 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11387 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11388 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011389 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11390 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11391
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011392transparent
11393 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11394 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11395 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11396 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11397 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11398 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11399 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11400 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11401 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11402 so check for support with your vendor.
11403
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011404v4v6
11405 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11406 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11407 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11408 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011409 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011410
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011411v6only
11412 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11413 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11414 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011415 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11416 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011417
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011418uid <uid>
11419 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11420 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11421 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11422 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11423 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11424
11425user <user>
11426 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11427 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11428 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11429 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11430 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11431
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011432verify [none|optional|required]
11433 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11434 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11435 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11436 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11437 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011438 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11439 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11440 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11441 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011442
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200114435.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011444------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011445
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011446The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11447which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11448arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11449settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11450after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11451Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11452address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011453
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011454 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011455 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011456
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011457Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11458keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11459
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011460The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011461
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011462addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011463 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011464 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11465 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11466 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11467 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11468 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011469
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011470agent-check
11471 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011472 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011473 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11474 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11475 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011476
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011477 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011478 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011479 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11480 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11481 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011482
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011483 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11484 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11485 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11486 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11487 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011488
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011489 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011490 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011491
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011492 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11493 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11494 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011495
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011496 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11497 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11498 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011499
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011500 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11501 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11502 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11503 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11504 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011505 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011506 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011507
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011508 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11509 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011510
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011511 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11512 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11513 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11514 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11515 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11516 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11517 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11518 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11519 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011520
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011521 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11522 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011523 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11524 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11525 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011526 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011527
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011528 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011529 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011530
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011531agent-send <string>
11532 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11533 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11534 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11535 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11536 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11537
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011538agent-inter <delay>
11539 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11540 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11541
11542 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11543 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11544 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11545 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11546 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11547 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11548 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11549 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11550 of backends use the same servers.
11551
11552 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11553
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011554agent-addr <addr>
11555 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11556
11557 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11558 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11559 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11560 hostname, it will be resolved.
11561
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011562agent-port <port>
11563 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11564
11565 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11566
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011567alpn <protocols>
11568 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11569 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11570 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11571 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11572 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11573 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11574 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11575 now obsolete NPN extension.
11576 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11577 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11578
11579 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11580
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011581backup
11582 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11583 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11584 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11585 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011586 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11587 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011588
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011589ca-file <cafile>
11590 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11591 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11592 server's certificate.
11593
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011594check
11595 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011596 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11597 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11598 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11599 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11600 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11601 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11602 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011603 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11604 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011605 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11606 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011607
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011608check-send-proxy
11609 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11610 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11611 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11612 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11613 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11614 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11615 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11616
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011617check-alpn <protocols>
11618 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11619 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11620 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11621
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011622check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011623 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011624 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11625 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011626
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011627check-ssl
11628 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11629 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11630 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11631 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011632 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011633 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11634 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011635 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011636 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11637 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011638
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011639ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011640 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11641 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11642 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011643 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11644 information and recommendations see e.g.
11645 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11646 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11647 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011648
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011649ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11650 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11651 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11652 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11653 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011654 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11655 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11656 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011657
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011658cookie <value>
11659 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11660 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11661 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11662 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11663 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11664 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11665 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11666
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011667crl-file <crlfile>
11668 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11669 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11670 to verify server's certificate.
11671
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011672crt <cert>
11673 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11674 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11675 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11676 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11677 certificate request.
11678
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011679disabled
11680 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11681 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11682 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11683 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11684 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011685 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011686
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011687enabled
11688 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11689 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11690 default value.
11691 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11692 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011693
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011694error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011695 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11696 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11697 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011698
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011699 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011700
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011701fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011702 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11703 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11704 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11705
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011706force-sslv3
11707 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11708 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011709 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011710 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011711
11712force-tlsv10
11713 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011714 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011715 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011716
11717force-tlsv11
11718 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011719 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011720 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011721
11722force-tlsv12
11723 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011724 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011725 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011726
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011727force-tlsv13
11728 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11729 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011730 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011731
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011732id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011733 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11734 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11735 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011736
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011737init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11738 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11739 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011740 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011741 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11742 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11743 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11744 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11745 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11746 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11747 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11748 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11749 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011750 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011751 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11752 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11753 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11754 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11755 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11756 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011757 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011758
11759 Example:
11760 defaults
11761 # never fail on address resolution
11762 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11763
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011764inter <delay>
11765fastinter <delay>
11766downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011767 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11768 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11769 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11770 between checks depending on the server state :
11771
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011772 Server state | Interval used
11773 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11774 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11775 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11776 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11777 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11778 or yet unchecked. |
11779 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11780 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11781 | "inter" otherwise.
11782 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011783
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011784 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11785 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11786 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11787 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011788 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11789 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11790 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11791 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11792 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011793
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011794maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011795 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11796 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11797 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11798 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11799 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11800 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11801 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11802 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11803
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011804maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011805 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11806 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11807 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11808 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11809 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11810 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11811 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11812
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011813max-reuse <count>
11814 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11815 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11816 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11817 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11818 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11819 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11820 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11821 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11822
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011823minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011824 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11825 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11826 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11827 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11828 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11829 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011830 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011831 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011832
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011833namespace <name>
11834 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11835 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11836 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11837 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11838
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011839no-agent-check
11840 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11841 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11842 default value.
11843 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11844 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11845
11846no-backup
11847 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11848 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11849 default value.
11850 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11851 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11852
11853no-check
11854 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11855 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11856 default value.
11857 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11858 "default-server" "check" setting.
11859
11860no-check-ssl
11861 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11862 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11863 default value.
11864 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11865 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11866
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011867no-send-proxy
11868 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11869 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11870 default value.
11871 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11872 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11873
11874no-send-proxy-v2
11875 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11876 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11877 default value.
11878 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11879 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11880
11881no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11882 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11883 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11884 default value.
11885 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11886 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11887
11888no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11889 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11890 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11891 default value.
11892 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11893 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11894
11895no-ssl
11896 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11897 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11898 default value.
11899 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11900 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11901
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011902no-ssl-reuse
11903 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11904 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11905 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11906 and for paranoid users.
11907
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011908no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011909 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11910 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011911 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011912
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011913 Supported in default-server: No
11914
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011915no-tls-tickets
11916 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11917 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11918 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011919 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11920 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011921 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011922
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011923no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011924 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011925 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11926 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011927 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11928 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011929 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011930
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011931 Supported in default-server: No
11932
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011933no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011934 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011935 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11936 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011937 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11938 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011939 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011940
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011941 Supported in default-server: No
11942
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011943no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011944 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011945 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11946 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011947 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11948 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011949 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011950
11951 Supported in default-server: No
11952
11953no-tlsv13
11954 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11955 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11956 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11957 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11958 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011959 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011960
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011961 Supported in default-server: No
11962
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011963no-verifyhost
11964 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11965 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11966 default value.
11967 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11968 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011969
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011970non-stick
11971 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11972 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11973 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11974
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011975npn <protocols>
11976 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11977 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11978 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11979 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11980 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
11981 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11982 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
11983
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011984observe <mode>
11985 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11986 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11987 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11988 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11989 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11990 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011991 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011992
11993 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11994
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011995on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011996 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11997 Currently, four modes are available:
11998 - fastinter: force fastinter
11999 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12000 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12001 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12002 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12003
12004 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12005
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012006on-marked-down <action>
12007 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12008 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012009 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12010 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12011 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12012 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12013 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12014 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12015 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12016 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012017
12018 Actions are disabled by default
12019
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012020on-marked-up <action>
12021 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12022 Currently one action is available:
12023 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12024 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12025 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12026 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012027 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12028 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012029 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12030 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12031
12032 Actions are disabled by default
12033
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012034pool-max-conn <max>
12035 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12036 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12037 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12038 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12039 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12040 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12041
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012042pool-purge-delay <delay>
12043 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012044 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
12045 The default is 1s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012046
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012047port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012048 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12049 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12050 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12051 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12052 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12053 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12054
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012055proto <name>
12056
12057 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12058 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12059 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12060 reported in haproxy -vv.
12061 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12062 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012064redir <prefix>
12065 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12066 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12067 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12068 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12069 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12070 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12071 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12072 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012073 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012074 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012075 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12076 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12077 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12078 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12079
12080 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12081
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012082rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012083 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12084 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12085 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12086
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012087resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12088 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12089 server.
12090
12091 Available options:
12092
12093 * allow-dup-ip
12094 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12095 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12096 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12097 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12098 For such case, simply enable this option.
12099 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12100
12101 * prevent-dup-ip
12102 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12103 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12104 same fqdn.
12105 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12106
12107 Example:
12108 backend b_myapp
12109 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12110 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12111 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12112
12113 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12114 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12115 it
12116 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12117 different address
12118
12119 Default value: not set
12120
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012121resolve-prefer <family>
12122 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12123 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12124 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12125 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12126
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012127 Default value: ipv6
12128
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012129 Example:
12130
12131 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012132
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012133resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
12134 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
12135 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012136 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012137 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12138 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012139 configured network, another address is selected.
12140
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012141 Example:
12142
12143 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012144
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012145resolvers <id>
12146 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12147 hostname.
12148
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012149 Example:
12150
12151 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012152
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012153 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012154
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012155send-proxy
12156 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12157 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12158 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12159 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012160 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12161 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12162 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12163 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12164 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12165 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12166 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12167 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12168 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12169 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012170 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12171 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012172
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012173send-proxy-v2
12174 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12175 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12176 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12177 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012178 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12179 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12180 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12181 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012182
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012183proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12184 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12185 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012186 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12187 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012188 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12189 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012190 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012191
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012192send-proxy-v2-ssl
12193 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12194 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12195 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12196 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12197 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12198 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12199 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012200 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12201 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012202
12203send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12204 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12205 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12206 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12207 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12208 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12209 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12210 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12211 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012212 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12213 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012214
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012215slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012216 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12217 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12218 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12219 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12220 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12221 parameters :
12222
12223 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12224 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12225
12226 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12227 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12228 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12229 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12230
12231 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12232 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12233 seen as failed.
12234
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012235sni <expression>
12236 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12237 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12238 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12239 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012240 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12241 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012242 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012243 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12244 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012245
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012246source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012247source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012248source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012249 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12250 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12251 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12252 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12253
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012254 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12255 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12256 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12257 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12258 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12259 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12260 server.
12261
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012262 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12263 specifying the source address without port(s).
12264
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012265ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012266 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12267 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12268 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12269 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12270 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12271 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012272 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12273 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012274
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012275ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12276 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12277 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12278 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12279
12280ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12281 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12282 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12283 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12284
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012285ssl-reuse
12286 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12287 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12288 default value.
12289 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12290 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12291
12292stick
12293 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12294 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12295 default value.
12296 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12297 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012298
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012299tcp-ut <delay>
12300 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12301 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12302 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012303 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012304 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12305 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12306 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12307 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12308 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12309 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12310 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12311 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12312 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12313
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012314track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012315 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12316 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12317 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12318 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012319 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12320
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012321tls-tickets
12322 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12323 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12324 default value.
12325 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12326 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012327
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012328verify [none|required]
12329 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012330 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012331 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12332 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012333 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012334 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12335 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12336 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12337 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12338 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12339 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12340 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12341 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012342
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012343verifyhost <hostname>
12344 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012345 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12346 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12347 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12348 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12349 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12350 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12351 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12352 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012353
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012354weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012355 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12356 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12357 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012358 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12359 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12360 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12361 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12362 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12363 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012364
12365
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123665.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12367-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012368
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012369HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12370using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12371configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012372This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12373can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12374workload.
12375This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12376resolution at run time.
12377Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12378carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12379
12380
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123815.3.1. Global overview
12382----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012383
12384As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12385different steps of the process life:
12386
12387 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12388 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12389 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12390
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012391 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12392 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012393
12394A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12395 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12396 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12397 resolution to know this new IP.
12398
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012399When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012400HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012401SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12402from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12403will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12404will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012405
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012406A few things important to notice:
12407 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12408 first valid response.
12409
12410 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12411 servers return an error.
12412
12413
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124145.3.2. The resolvers section
12415----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012416
12417This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012418HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12419contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012420
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012421When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12422uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12423is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12424answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12425
12426When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012427used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012428
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012429 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12430 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12431 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012432
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012433 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12434 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012435
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012436 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12437 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12438 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012439
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012440For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12441following scenarios are possible:
12442
12443 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12444 ignored
12445
12446 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12447 applied
12448
12449 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12450 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12451
12452 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12453 retries the query with a new type
12454
12455 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12456 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012457
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012458As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12459a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012460<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012461
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012462
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012463resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012464 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012465
12466A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12467
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012468accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012469 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012470 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012471 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12472 by RFC 6891)
12473
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012474 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12475
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012476nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12477 DNS server description:
12478 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12479 <ip> : IP address of the server
12480 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12481
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012482parse-resolv-conf
12483 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12484 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12485 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12486
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012487hold <status> <period>
12488 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12489 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012490 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012491 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012492 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12493 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12494 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12495
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012496 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012497
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012498resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012499 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12500 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12501 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12502
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012503resolve_retries <nb>
12504 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12505 giving up.
12506 Default value: 3
12507
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012508 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12509 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12510 type.
12511
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012512timeout <event> <time>
12513 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12514 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12515 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012516 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12517 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012518 Default value: 1s
12519 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012520 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012521 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012522 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12523 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12524
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012525 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012526
12527 resolvers mydns
12528 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12529 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012530 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012531 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012532 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012533 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012534 hold other 30s
12535 hold refused 30s
12536 hold nx 30s
12537 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012538 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012539 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012540
12541
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125426. HTTP header manipulation
12543---------------------------
12544
12545In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12546response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12547request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12548which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012549against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012550
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012551If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12552to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12553but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12554HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12555stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12556because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12557a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12558still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012560This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12561in section 4.2 :
12562
12563 - reqadd <string>
12564 - reqallow <search>
12565 - reqiallow <search>
12566 - reqdel <search>
12567 - reqidel <search>
12568 - reqdeny <search>
12569 - reqideny <search>
12570 - reqpass <search>
12571 - reqipass <search>
12572 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12573 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12574 - reqtarpit <search>
12575 - reqitarpit <search>
12576 - rspadd <string>
12577 - rspdel <search>
12578 - rspidel <search>
12579 - rspdeny <search>
12580 - rspideny <search>
12581 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12582 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12583
12584With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12585is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12586parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12587prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12588Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12589
12590 \t for a tab
12591 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12592 \n for a new line (LF)
12593 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12594 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12595 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12596 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12597 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12598
12599The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12600portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12601above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12602regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
126039 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12604is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12605
12606The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12607after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12608
12609Notes related to these keywords :
12610---------------------------------
12611 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12612 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12613 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12614
12615 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12616 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12617 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12618
12619 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12620 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12621 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12622 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12623 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12624
12625 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12626 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12627 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12628 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12629 useless headers before adding new ones.
12630
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012631 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012632 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12633
12634 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12635 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12636 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12637
12638 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12639 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012640 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012641
12642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126437. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12644----------------------------------
12645
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012646HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012647client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12648The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12649these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12650but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12651data called patterns.
12652
12653
126547.1. ACL basics
12655---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012656
12657The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12658content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12659from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12660simple :
12661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012662 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012663 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012664 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12665 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012667The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12668adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012669
12670In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012672 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012673
12674This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12675Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12676and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012677an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12678conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12679as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12680are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012681
12682ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12683'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12684which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12685
12686There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12687performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012689The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12690specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12691this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012692methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12693ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012694
12695Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12696 - boolean
12697 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12698 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12699 - string
12700 - data block
12701
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012702Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12703converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12704would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12705The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12706which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12707
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012708Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12709keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12710fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12711which are summarized in the table below :
12712
12713 +---------------------+-----------------+
12714 | Sample or converter | Default |
12715 | output type | matching method |
12716 +---------------------+-----------------+
12717 | boolean | bool |
12718 +---------------------+-----------------+
12719 | integer | int |
12720 +---------------------+-----------------+
12721 | ip | ip |
12722 +---------------------+-----------------+
12723 | string | str |
12724 +---------------------+-----------------+
12725 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12726 +---------------------+-----------------+
12727
12728Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12729matching method, see below.
12730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012731The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12732 - boolean
12733 - integer or integer range
12734 - IP address / network
12735 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12736 - regular expression
12737 - hex block
12738
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012739The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12740
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012741 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12742 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012743 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012744 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012745 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012746 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012747 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012749The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12750read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12751if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12752lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12753will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12754beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12755a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12756lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12757exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12758
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012759The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12760parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12761ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12762a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12763check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12764
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012765The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12766socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12767file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012769Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12770loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12771
12772 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12773
12774In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12775the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12776case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12777as well.
12778
12779The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12780sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12781do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12782methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12783is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012784obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012785followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12786default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12787that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12788string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12789
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012790The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12791By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12792string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12793resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12794server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12795waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12796flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12797function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012799There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12800sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12801be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012802
12803 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12804 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012805 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12806 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12807 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12808 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012809
12810 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12811 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012812 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012813
12814 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012815 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012816
12817 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012818 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012819
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012820 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012821 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12822
12823 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12824 binary or string samples.
12825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012826 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12827 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012829 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12830 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12831 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012833 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12834 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012836 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12837 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012839 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12840 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012842 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12843 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012844 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012846 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12847 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12848 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012849
12850For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12851request, it is possible to do :
12852
12853 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12854
12855In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12856buffer, one would use the following acl :
12857
12858 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12859
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012860On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12861possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12862
12863 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012865All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12866criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12867method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12868to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12869criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12870the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012872If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012873the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12874For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012876 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12877 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12878 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12879 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012880
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012881
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012882The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12883types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12884combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12885brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12886default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012888 +-------------------------------------------------+
12889 | Input sample type |
12890 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012891 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012892 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12893 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12894 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012895 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012896 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012897 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012898 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012899 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012900 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012901 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012902 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012903 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012904 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012905 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012906 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012907 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012908 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012909 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012910 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012911 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012912 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012913 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012914 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012915 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012916 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12917 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12918 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012919
12920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129217.1.1. Matching booleans
12922------------------------
12923
12924In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12925Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12926When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12927that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12928
12929Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12930return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12931"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12932
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129347.1.2. Matching integers
12935------------------------
12936
12937Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12938enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12939to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12940
12941Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12942matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12943lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012944
12945For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12946unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12947representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12948
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012949As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12950two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12951instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12952ranges and operators.
12953
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012954For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012955operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12956Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12957of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012958
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012959Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012960
12961 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12962 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12963 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12964 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12965 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12966
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012967For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012968
12969 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12970
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012971This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12972
12973 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12974
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129767.1.3. Matching strings
12977-----------------------
12978
12979String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12980different forms :
12981
12982 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012983 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012984
12985 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012986 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012987
12988 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12989 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12990
12991 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12992 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12993
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012994 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012995 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12996 matches.
12997
12998 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12999 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13000 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013001
13002String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13003exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13004characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13005string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13006to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013007before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013008
13009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130107.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13011---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013012
13013Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13014they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13015possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13016passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13017the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013018the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13019match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013020
13021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130227.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13023-------------------------------------
13024
13025It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13026not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13027a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13028to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13029digits may be used upper or lower case.
13030
13031Example :
13032 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13033 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13034
13035
130367.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13037---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013038
13039IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13040netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13041within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013042host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013043difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13044at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13045does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13046parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013047
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013048The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13049abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13050
13051 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13052 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13053 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13054 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13055 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13056 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13057 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13058 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13059
13060Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13061192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13062
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013063IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13064Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13065trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13066IPv6 patterns.
13067
13068HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13069following situations :
13070 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13071 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13072 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13073 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13074 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13075 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13076 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13077 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13078 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13079 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013081
130827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13083----------------------------------
13084
13085Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13086combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13087
13088 - AND (implicit)
13089 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13090 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013092A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013094 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013096Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13097indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013099For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13100"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13101requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13102is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13103
13104 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013105 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13106 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13107 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013108
13109To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13110and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13111
13112 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13113 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13114 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13115 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13116
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013117 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013118 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13119 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13120 use_backend www if host_www
13121
13122It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13123expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13124be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13125the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13126
13127 The following rule :
13128
13129 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013130 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013131
13132 Can also be written that way :
13133
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013134 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013135
13136It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13137to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13138simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13139sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13140good use is the following :
13141
13142 With named ACLs :
13143
13144 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13145 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13146 monitor fail if site_dead
13147
13148 With anonymous ACLs :
13149
13150 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13151
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013152See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13153keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013154
13155
131567.3. Fetching samples
13157---------------------
13158
13159Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13160against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13161sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13162ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13163of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13164available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13165
13166This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13167Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13168compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13169deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13170
13171The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13172matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13173method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13174indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13175
13176As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13177when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13178mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13179the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13180ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13181
13182Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13183multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13184when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013185incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13186are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013187is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13188all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13189
13190Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13191 - name
13192 - name(arg1)
13193 - name(arg1,arg2)
13194
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013195
131967.3.1. Converters
13197-----------------
13198
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013199Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13200of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13201is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13202was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013203has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013204unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13205
13206These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13207sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13208the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013209support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013210
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013211A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13212support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13213supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13214(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13215bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013217The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013218
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001321951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13220 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13221 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13222 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13223 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13224 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13225
13226 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013227 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13228 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013229 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13230 frontend http-in
13231 bind *:8081
13232 default_backend servers
13233 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13234 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13235
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013236add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013237 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013238 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013239 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13240 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013241 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013242 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13243 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13244 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13245 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013246 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013247 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013248
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013249aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13250 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13251 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13252 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13253 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13254 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13255 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13256
13257 Example:
13258 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13259 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13260
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013261and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013262 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013263 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013264 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13265 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013266 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013267 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13268 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13269 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13270 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013271 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013272 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013273
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013274b64dec
13275 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13276 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13277
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013278base64
13279 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013280 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013281 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13282
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013283bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013284 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013285 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013286 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013287 presence of a flag).
13288
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013289bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13290 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13291 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013292 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013293
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013294concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13295 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13296 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13297 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13298 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13299 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13300 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13301 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13302 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13303 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13304 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13305 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13306 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13307 delimitors.
13308
13309 Example:
13310 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13311 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13312 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13313 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13314
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013315cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013316 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13317 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013318
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013319crc32([<avalanche>])
13320 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13321 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13322 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13323 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13324 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13325 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13326 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13327 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13328 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13329 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013330 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13331
13332crc32c([<avalanche>])
13333 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13334 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13335 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13336 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13337 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13338 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13339 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13340 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013341
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013342da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013343 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13344 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13345 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13346 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013347 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013348 configuration language.
13349
13350 Example:
13351 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013352 bind *:8881
13353 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013354 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013355
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013356debug
13357 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13358 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13359 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13360
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013361div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013362 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13363 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013364 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013365 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13366 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013367 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013368 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13369 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13370 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13371 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013372 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013373 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013374
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013375djb2([<avalanche>])
13376 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13377 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13378 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13379 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13380 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13381 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13382 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013383 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13384 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013385
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013386even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013387 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013388 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13389
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013390field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13391 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13392 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13393 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13394 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13395 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13396 fields.
13397
13398 Example :
13399 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13400 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13401 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13402 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13403 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013404
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013405hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013406 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013407 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013408 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013409 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013410
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013411hex2i
13412 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13413 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13414
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013415http_date([<offset>])
13416 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13417 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13418 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13419 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13420 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13421 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013422
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013423in_table(<table>)
13424 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13425 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13426 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013427 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013428 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13429
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013430ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13431 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013432 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013433 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13434 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13435 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13436 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13437 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013438
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013439json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013440 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013441 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013442 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013443 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13444 of errors:
13445 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13446 bytes, ...)
13447 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13448 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13449
13450 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13451 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13452 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13453 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13454 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13455 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013456 - "ascii" : never fails;
13457 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13458 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013459 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013460 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013461 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13462 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13463
13464 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013465 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013466
13467 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013468 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013469 capture request header user-agent len 150
13470 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013471
13472 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13473 GET / HTTP/1.0
13474 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13475
13476 Output log:
13477 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13478
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013479language(<value>[,<default>])
13480 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13481 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13482 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13483 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13484 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13485 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13486 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13487 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13488 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013489 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013490 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13491 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013492
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013493 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013494
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013495 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13496 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013497
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013498 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13499 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13500 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13501 use_backend spanish if es
13502 use_backend french if fr
13503 use_backend english if en
13504 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013505
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013506length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013507 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13508 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13509 type. The result is of type integer.
13510
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013511lower
13512 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13513 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13514 type. The result is of type string.
13515
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013516ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13517 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13518 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13519 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13520 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13521 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13522 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13523
13524 Example :
13525
13526 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013527 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013528 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13529
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013530map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13531map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13532map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13533 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13534 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13535 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13536 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13537 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13538 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13539 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13540 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013541
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013542 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13543 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13544 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013545
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013546 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013547 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013548
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013549 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13550 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13551 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13552 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013553 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13554 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013555 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13556 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13557 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13558 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13559 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13560 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13561 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13562 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013563 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13564 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13565 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013566 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13567 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13568 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13569 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13570 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013571
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013572 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13573 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13574 the corresponding match text.
13575
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013576 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13577 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13578 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13579 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13580 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013581
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013582 Example :
13583
13584 # this is a comment and is ignored
13585 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13586 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13587 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13588 | | | `---------- value
13589 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13590 | `---------------------------- key
13591 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13592
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013593mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013594 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13595 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013596 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013597 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013598 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013599 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13600 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13601 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13602 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013603 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013604 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013605
13606mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013607 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013608 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13609 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013610 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013611 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013612 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013613 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13614 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13615 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13616 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013617 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013618 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013619
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013620nbsrv
13621 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13622 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13623 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13624 map lookup.
13625
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013626neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013627 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13628 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13629 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13630 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013631
13632not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013633 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013634 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013635 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013636 absence of a flag).
13637
13638odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013639 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013640 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13641
13642or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013643 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013644 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013645 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13646 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013647 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013648 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13649 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13650 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13651 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013652 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013653 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013654
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013655protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13656 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13657 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13658 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13659 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13660 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13661 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13662 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13663 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13664 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13665 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13666 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13667
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013668regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013669 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13670 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13671 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13672 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13673 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13674 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13675 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13676 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13677 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13678 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013679 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13680 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13681 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13682 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013683
13684 Example :
13685
13686 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13687 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13688 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13689 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13690
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013691capture-req(<id>)
13692 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13693 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13694
13695 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013696 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13697 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013698
13699capture-res(<id>)
13700 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13701 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13702
13703 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013704 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13705 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013706
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013707sdbm([<avalanche>])
13708 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13709 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13710 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13711 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13712 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13713 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13714 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013715 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13716 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013717
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013718set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013719 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13720 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13721 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013722 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013723 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13724 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013725 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013726 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13727 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013728 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013729 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013730
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013731sha1
13732 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13733 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13734
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013735strcmp(<var>)
13736 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13737 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13738 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13739 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13740 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13741 shorter).
13742
13743 Example :
13744
13745 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13746 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13747 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13748
13749
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013750sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013751 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13752 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013753 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013754 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13755 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013756 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013757 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13758 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013759 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013760 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13761 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013762 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013763 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013764
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013765table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13766 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13767 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13768 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13769 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13770 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13771 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13772
13773
13774table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13775 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13776 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13777 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13778 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13779 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13780 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13781
13782table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13783 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13784 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013785 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013786 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13787 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13788
13789table_conn_cur(<table>)
13790 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13791 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13792 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13793 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13794 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13795
13796table_conn_rate(<table>)
13797 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13798 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13799 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13800 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13801 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13802
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013803table_gpt0(<table>)
13804 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13805 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13806 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13807 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13808 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13809
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013810table_gpc0(<table>)
13811 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13812 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13813 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13814 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13815 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13816
13817table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13818 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13819 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13820 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13821 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13822 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13823 sample fetch keyword.
13824
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013825table_gpc1(<table>)
13826 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13827 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13828 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13829 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13830 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13831
13832table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13833 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13834 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13835 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13836 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13837 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13838 sample fetch keyword.
13839
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013840table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13841 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13842 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013843 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013844 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13845 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13846
13847table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13848 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13849 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13850 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13851 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13852 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13853 keyword.
13854
13855table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13856 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13857 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013858 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013859 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13860 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13861
13862table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13863 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13864 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13865 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13866 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13867 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13868 keyword.
13869
13870table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13871 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13872 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013873 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013874 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13875 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13876 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13877 keyword.
13878
13879table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13880 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13881 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013882 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013883 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13884 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13885 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13886 keyword.
13887
13888table_server_id(<table>)
13889 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13890 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13891 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13892 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13893 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13894 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13895
13896table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13897 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13898 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013899 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013900 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13901 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13902 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13903 keyword.
13904
13905table_sess_rate(<table>)
13906 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13907 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13908 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13909 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13910 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13911 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13912 keyword.
13913
13914table_trackers(<table>)
13915 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13916 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13917 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13918 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13919 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13920 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13921 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13922 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13923 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13924 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13925
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013926upper
13927 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13928 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13929 type. The result is of type string.
13930
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013931url_dec
13932 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13933 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13934
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013935ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013936 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013937 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
13938 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
13939 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013940 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13941 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13942 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13943 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013944 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013945 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13946 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013947
13948 Example:
13949 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
13950 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
13951
13952 message Point {
13953 int32 latitude = 1;
13954 int32 longitude = 2;
13955 }
13956
13957 message PPoint {
13958 Point point = 59;
13959 }
13960
13961 message Rectangle {
13962 // One corner of the rectangle.
13963 PPoint lo = 48;
13964 // The other corner of the rectangle.
13965 PPoint hi = 49;
13966 }
13967
13968 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
13969 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
13970 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
13971
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013972 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13973 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13974 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latidude" of "hi" second PPoint
13975 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
13976
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013977 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013978
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013979 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013980
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013981 As a gRPC message is alway made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
13982 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13983 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
13984
13985 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
13986 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
13987 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
13988
13989 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
13990 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
13991 interpret the previous binary sample.
13992
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013993
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013994unset-var(<var name>)
13995 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13996 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13997 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13998 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13999 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14000 response),
14001 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14002 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14003 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14004 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14005
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014006utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14007 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14008 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14009 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14010 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14011 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14012 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14013
14014 Example :
14015
14016 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014017 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014018 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14019
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014020word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14021 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14022 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14023 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14024 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14025 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14026
14027 Example :
14028 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14029 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14030 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14031 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14032 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014033
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014034wt6([<avalanche>])
14035 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14036 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14037 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14038 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14039 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14040 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14041 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014042 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14043 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014044
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014045xor(<value>)
14046 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014047 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014048 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014049 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014050 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014051 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14052 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014053 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014054 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14055 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014056 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014057 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014058
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014059xxh32([<seed>])
14060 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14061 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14062 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14063 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14064 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14065 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14066 as cryptographically secure.
14067
14068xxh64([<seed>])
14069 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14070 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14071 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14072 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14073 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14074 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14075 as cryptographically secure.
14076
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014077
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140787.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014079--------------------------------------------
14080
14081A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14082not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14083"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14084The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14085
14086always_false : boolean
14087 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14088 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14089
14090always_true : boolean
14091 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14092 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14093
14094avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014095 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014096 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14097 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14098 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14099 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14100 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14101 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14102 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14103 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14104 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14105 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14106 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14107 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14108 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014110be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014111 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14112 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14113 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14114 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014115 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14116
14117be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14118 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14119 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14120 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14121 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14122 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014123 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14124 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014125
14126 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14127 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14128 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014130be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14131 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14132 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14133 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014134 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014135 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14136 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014137
14138 Example :
14139 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14140 backend dynamic
14141 mode http
14142 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14143 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014144
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014145bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014146 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14147 of the string.
14148
14149bool(<bool>) : bool
14150 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14151 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014153connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14154 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014155 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014156 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14157 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014158
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014159 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014160 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014161 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14162
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014163 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14164 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014165
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014166 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014167 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014168 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014169 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014170 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014171 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014172 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014173
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014174 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14175 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014176 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014177 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014178
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014179cpu_calls : integer
14180 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14181 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14182 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14183 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14184 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14185 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14186
14187cpu_ns_avg : integer
14188 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14189 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14190 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14191 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14192 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14193 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14194 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14195 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14196 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14197 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14198 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14199
14200cpu_ns_tot : integer
14201 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14202 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14203 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14204 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14205 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14206 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14207 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14208 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14209 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14210 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14211 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14212 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14213 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14214
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014215date([<offset>]) : integer
14216 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14217 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14218 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14219 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014220 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14221
14222 Example :
14223
14224 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14225 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014226
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014227date_us : integer
14228 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14229 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14230 from the same timeval structure.
14231
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014232distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14233 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14234 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14235 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14236 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14237 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14238 list of supported tokens.
14239
14240distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14241 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14242 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14243 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14244 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14245 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14246 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14247 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14248 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14249 supported tokens.
14250
14251 Example :
14252 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14253 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14254 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14255 # send large files to the big farm
14256 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14257
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014258env(<name>) : string
14259 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14260 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14261 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14262 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14263 certain way.
14264
14265 Examples :
14266 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14267 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14268
14269 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14270 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014272fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14273 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014274 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14275 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014276 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14277 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014278 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014279 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14280 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014281
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014282fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14283 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14284 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14285 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014287fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14288 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14289 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14290 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14291 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14292 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14293 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14294 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14295 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014296
14297 Example :
14298 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14299 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14300 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14301 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14302 frontend mail
14303 bind :25
14304 mode tcp
14305 maxconn 100
14306 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14307 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14308 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14309 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014310
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014311hostname : string
14312 Returns the system hostname.
14313
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014314int(<integer>) : signed integer
14315 Returns a signed integer.
14316
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014317ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14318 Returns an ipv4.
14319
14320ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14321 Returns an ipv6.
14322
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014323lat_ns_avg : integer
14324 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14325 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14326 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14327 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14328 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14329 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14330 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14331 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14332 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14333 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14334 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14335 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14336 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14337 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14338
14339lat_ns_tot : integer
14340 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14341 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14342 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14343 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14344 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14345 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14346 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14347 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14348 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14349 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14350 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14351 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14352 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14353 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14354 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14355 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14356 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14357 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14358 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14359
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014360meth(<method>) : method
14361 Returns a method.
14362
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014363nbproc : integer
14364 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14365 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14366 and debugging purposes.
14367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014368nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14369 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14370 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14371 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014372 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14373 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14374 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014375
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014376prio_class : integer
14377 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14378 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14379 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14380
14381prio_offset : integer
14382 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14383 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14384 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14385 set-priority-offset".
14386
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014387proc : integer
14388 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14389 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14390 debugging purposes.
14391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014392queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014393 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14394 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14395 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014396 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14397 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14398 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14399 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14400 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14401
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014402rand([<range>]) : integer
14403 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14404 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14405 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14406 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14407 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014409srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14410 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14411 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14412 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14413 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14414 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014415 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14416 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14417
14418srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14419 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14420 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14421 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14422 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14423 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14424 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14425 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14426
14427 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14428 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014429
14430srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14431 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14432 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14433 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014434 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014435 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14436 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14437 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14438
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014439srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14440 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14441 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14442 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14443 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14444 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14445 fetch methods.
14446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014447srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14448 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14449 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014450 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014451 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14452 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014453 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014454 overloading servers).
14455
14456 Example :
14457 # Redirect to a separate back
14458 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14459 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14460 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14461
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014462stopping : boolean
14463 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14464 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14465 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14466
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014467str(<string>) : string
14468 Returns a string.
14469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014470table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14471 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14472 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14473
14474table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14475 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14476 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14477 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14478
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014479thread : integer
14480 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14481 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14482 and debugging purposes.
14483
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014484var(<var-name>) : undefined
14485 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014486 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14487 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014488 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014489 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14490 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014491 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014492 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14493 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014494 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014495 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014496
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144977.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014498----------------------------------
14499
14500The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14501closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14502methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14503sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14504TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014505the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14506counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014507"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14508used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14509can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14510Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14511table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14512tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14513currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014514
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014515bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014516 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14517 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14518 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014520be_id : integer
14521 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14522 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14523
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014524be_name : string
14525 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14526 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014528dst : ip
14529 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14530 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14531 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14532 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014533 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14534 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14535 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14536 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14537 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14538 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014539
14540dst_conn : integer
14541 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14542 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14543 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14544 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14545 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14546 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14547 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14548 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014549
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014550dst_is_local : boolean
14551 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14552 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14553 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14554 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014555 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014556 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14557 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14558 it only once per connection.
14559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014560dst_port : integer
14561 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14562 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14563 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14564 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14565 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14566 an HTTP header.
14567
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014568fc_http_major : integer
14569 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14570 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14571 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14572
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014573fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14574 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14575 header.
14576
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014577fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14578 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14579 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14580 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14581 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14582 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14583 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14584
14585fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14586 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14587 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14588 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14589 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14590 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14591 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14592
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014593fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14594 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14595 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14596 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14597 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14598
14599fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14600 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14601 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14602 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14603 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14604
14605fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14606 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14607 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14608 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14609 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14610
14611fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14612 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14613 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14614 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14615 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14616
14617fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14618 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14619 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14620 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14621 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14622
14623fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14624 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14625 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14626 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14627 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14628
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014629fe_defbe : string
14630 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14631 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014633fe_id : integer
14634 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014635 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014636 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14637
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014638fe_name : string
14639 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14640 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14641 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14642
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014643sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014644sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14645sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14646sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014647 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14648 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14649 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14650
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014651sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014652sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14653sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14654sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014655 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14656 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14657 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14658
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014659sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014660sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14661sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14662sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014663 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14664 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014665 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14666 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14667 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014668
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014669 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014670 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14671 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014672 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14673 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14674 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014675 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14676 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14677
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014678sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14679sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14680sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14681sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14682 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14683 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14684 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14685 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14686 when a first ACL was verified.
14687
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014688sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014689sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14690sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14691sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014692 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014693 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14694
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014695sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014696sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14697sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14698sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014699 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14700 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14701 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14702
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014703sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014704sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14705sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14706sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014707 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14708 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14709 See also src_conn_rate.
14710
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014711sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014712sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14713sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14714sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014715 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014716 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014717
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014718sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14719sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14720sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14721sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14722 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14723 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14724
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014725sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14726sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14727sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14728sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14729 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14730 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14731
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014732sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014733sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14734sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14735sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014736 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14737 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14738 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014739 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14740 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14741 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014742
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014743sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14744sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14745sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14746sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14747 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14748 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14749 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14750 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14751 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14752 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14753
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014754sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014755sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14756sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14757sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014758 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014759 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14760 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14761
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014762sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014763sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14764sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14765sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014766 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14767 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14768 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14769 src_http_err_rate.
14770
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014771sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014772sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14773sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14774sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014775 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014776 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14777 src_http_req_cnt.
14778
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014779sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014780sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14781sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14782sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014783 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14784 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14785 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14786 src_http_req_rate.
14787
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014788sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014789sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14790sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14791sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014792 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014793 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14794 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14795 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14796 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014797
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014798 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014799 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14800 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014801 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14802
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014803sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14804sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14805sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14806sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14807 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14808 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14809 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14810 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14811 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14812
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014813sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014814sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14815sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14816sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014817 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14818 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14819 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014820
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014821sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014822sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14823sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14824sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014825 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14826 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14827 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014828
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014829sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014830sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14831sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14832sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014833 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014834 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14835 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14836 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014837 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014838 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14839
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014840sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014841sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14842sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14843sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014844 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14845 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14846 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14847 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14848 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014849 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014850
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014851sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014852sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14853sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14854sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014855 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14856 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14857 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14858
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014859sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014860sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14861sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14862sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014863 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14864 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014865 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014866 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14867 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014868 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14869 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14870 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014872so_id : integer
14873 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14874 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14875 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014877src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014878 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014879 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14880 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14881 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014882 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14883 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14884 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014885 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
14886 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
14887 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
14888 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
14889 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
14890 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
14891 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014892
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014893 Example:
14894 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14895 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014897src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14898 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14899 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14900 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014901 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014903src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14904 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14905 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014906 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014907 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014909src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14910 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14911 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14912 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14913 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14914 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14915 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014916
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014917 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014918 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14919 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14920 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14921 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014922 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014923 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14924 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14925
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014926src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14927 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14928 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14929 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14930 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14931 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14932 was verified.
14933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014934src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014935 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014936 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014937 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014938 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014940src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014941 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014942 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14943 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014944 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014946src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14947 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14948 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14949 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014950 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014952src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014953 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014954 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014955 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014956 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014957
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014958src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14959 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14960 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14961 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14962 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14963
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014964src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14965 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14966 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14967 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14968 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014970src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014971 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014972 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014973 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14974 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014975 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14976 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14977 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014978
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014979src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14980 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14981 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14982 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14983 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14984 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14985 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14986 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014988src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014989 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014990 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014991 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014992 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014993 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014995src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14996 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14997 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14998 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14999 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015000 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015002src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015003 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015004 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15005 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015006 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015008src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15009 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15010 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15011 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015012 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015013 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015015src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15016 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15017 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15018 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015019 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015020 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15021 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015022
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015023 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015024 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015025 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015026 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015027
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015028src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15029 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15030 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15031 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15032 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15033 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15034 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15035
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015036src_is_local : boolean
15037 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15038 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15039 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15040 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015041 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015042 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15043 once per connection.
15044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015045src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015046 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15047 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15048 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15049 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15050 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015052src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015053 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15054 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15055 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15056 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15057 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015059src_port : integer
15060 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15061 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15062 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15063 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015065src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015066 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015067 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15068 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15069 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015070 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015072src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15073 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15074 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15075 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15076 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015077 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015079src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15080 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15081 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15082 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15083 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15084 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15085 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15086 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15087 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015088
15089 Example :
15090 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15091 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15092 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15093 listen ssh
15094 bind :22
15095 mode tcp
15096 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015097 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015098 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015099 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015101srv_id : integer
15102 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15103 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15104 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015105
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200151067.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015107----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015109The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15110closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15111when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15112usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015113future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015114
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001511551d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15116 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15117 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15118 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15119 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15120 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15121
15122 Example :
15123 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15124 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15125 # the request.
15126 frontend http-in
15127 bind *:8081
15128 default_backend servers
15129 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15130 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15131
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015132ssl_bc : boolean
15133 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15134 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15135 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15136
15137ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15138 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15139 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15140
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015141ssl_bc_alpn : string
15142 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15143 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
15144 The result is a string containing the protocol name negociated with the
15145 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15146 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15147 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15148 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15149 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15150 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15151
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015152ssl_bc_cipher : string
15153 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15154 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15155
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015156ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15157 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15158 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15159 session or a TLS ticket.
15160
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015161ssl_bc_npn : string
15162 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15163 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
15164 protocol name negociated with the server . The SSL library must have been
15165 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15166 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15167 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15168 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15169 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15170
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015171ssl_bc_protocol : string
15172 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15173 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15174
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015175ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015176 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015177 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15178 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015179
15180ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15181 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15182 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15183 if session was reused or not.
15184
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015185ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15186 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15187 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15188 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15189 BoringSSL.
15190
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015191ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15192 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15193 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015195ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15196 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15197 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15198 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15199 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15200 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015202ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15203 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15204 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15205 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15206 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015207
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015208ssl_c_der : binary
15209 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15210 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15211 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015213ssl_c_err : integer
15214 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15215 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15216 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15217 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15218 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015220ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15221 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15222 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15223 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15224 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15225 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15226 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15227 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15228 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015230ssl_c_key_alg : string
15231 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15232 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15233 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015235ssl_c_notafter : string
15236 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15237 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15238 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015240ssl_c_notbefore : string
15241 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15242 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15243 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015245ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15246 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15247 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15248 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15249 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15250 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15251 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15252 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15253 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015255ssl_c_serial : binary
15256 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15257 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15258 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015260ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15261 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15262 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15263 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015264 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15265 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15266
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015267 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015268 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015270ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15271 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15272 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15273 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015275ssl_c_used : boolean
15276 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15277 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015279ssl_c_verify : integer
15280 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15281 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15282 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15283 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015285ssl_c_version : integer
15286 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15287 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015288
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015289ssl_f_der : binary
15290 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15291 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15292 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015294ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15295 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15296 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15297 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15298 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015299 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015300 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15301 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15302 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015304ssl_f_key_alg : string
15305 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15306 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15307 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015309ssl_f_notafter : string
15310 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15311 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15312 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015314ssl_f_notbefore : string
15315 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15316 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15317 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015319ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15320 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15321 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15322 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15323 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15324 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15325 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15326 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15327 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015329ssl_f_serial : binary
15330 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15331 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15332 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015333
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015334ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15335 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15336 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15337 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015339ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15340 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15341 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15342 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015344ssl_f_version : integer
15345 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15346 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15347
15348ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015349 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15350 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15351 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015353 Example :
15354 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15355 listen http-https
15356 bind :80
15357 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15358 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15359
15360ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15361 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15362 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15363
15364ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015365 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015366 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15367 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15368 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15369 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15370 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15371 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15372 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15373 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015375ssl_fc_cipher : string
15376 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15377 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015378
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015379ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15380 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15381 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015382 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015383
15384ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15385 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15386 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015387 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015388
15389ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15390 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15391 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15392 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015393 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015394 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015395
15396ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15397 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15398 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015399 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015401ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015402 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15403 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015404 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15405 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15406 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15407 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015408
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015409ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15410 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15411 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15412 wait until the handshake happened.
15413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015414ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15415 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015416 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15417 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15418 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15419 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015420
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015421ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015422 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015423 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15424 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015426ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015427 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015428 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15429 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15430 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15431 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15432 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15433 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15434 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015436ssl_fc_protocol : string
15437 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15438 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015439
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015440ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015441 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015442 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15443 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015445ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15446 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15447 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15448 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15449 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015450
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015451ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15452 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15453 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15454 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15455 BoringSSL.
15456
15457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015458ssl_fc_sni : string
15459 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15460 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15461 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15462 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15463 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15464
15465 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15466 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15467 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015468 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15469 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015471 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015472 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15473 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015475ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15476 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15477 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015478
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015479
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200154807.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015481------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015483Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15484sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15485only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15486For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15487be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15488can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15489sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15490for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15491content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015493payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015494 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015495 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15496 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015498payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15499 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015500 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015501 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015502
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015503req.hdrs : string
15504 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15505 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15506 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15507 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15508
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015509req.hdrs_bin : binary
15510 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15511 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15512 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15513 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15514 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15515 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15516
15517 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15518
15519 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15520 str: <int:length><bytes>
15521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015522req.len : integer
15523req_len : integer (deprecated)
15524 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15525 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15526 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15527 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15528 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15529 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15530 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15531 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015533req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15534 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015535 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15536 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15537 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15538 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015540 ACL alternatives :
15541 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015543req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15544 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15545 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15546 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15547 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015549 ACL alternatives :
15550 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015552 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015554req.proto_http : boolean
15555req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15556 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15557 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15558 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15559 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15560 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15561 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15562 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015564 Example:
15565 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15566 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15567 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015568 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015570req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15571rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15572 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15573 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15574 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15575 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15576 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15577 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15578 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015580 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15581 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15582 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15583 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15584 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15585 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015587 ACL derivatives :
15588 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015590 Example :
15591 listen tse-farm
15592 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15593 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15594 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15595 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15596 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15597 persist rdp-cookie
15598 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15599 # This is only useful makes sense if
15600 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15601 stick-table type string size 204800
15602 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15603 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15604 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015606 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15607 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015609req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15610rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15611 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15612 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15613 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15614 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015616 ACL derivatives :
15617 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015618
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015619req.ssl_alpn : string
15620 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15621 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15622 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15623 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15624 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15625 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015626 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015627
15628 Examples :
15629 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15630 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15631 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015632 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015633 default_backend bk_default
15634
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015635req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15636 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15637 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015638 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15639 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15640 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15641 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15642 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015644req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15645req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15646 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15647 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15648 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15649 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15650 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15651 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15652 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015654req.ssl_sni : string
15655req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15656 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15657 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15658 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15659 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15660 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15661 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15662 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15663 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15664 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15665 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15666 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15667 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015669 ACL derivatives :
15670 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015672 Examples :
15673 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15674 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15675 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15676 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15677 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015678
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015679req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15680 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15681 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15682 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15683 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15684 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15685 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15686 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15687 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15688 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015690req.ssl_ver : integer
15691req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15692 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15693 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15694 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15695 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15696 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15697 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15698 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015699 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015700 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015702 ACL derivatives :
15703 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015704
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015705res.len : integer
15706 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15707 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15708 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15709 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15710 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15711 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15712 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15713 content inspection.
15714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015715res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15716 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015717 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15718 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15719 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15720 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015722res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15723 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15724 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15725 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15726 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015728 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015729
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015730res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15731rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15732 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15733 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15734 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15735 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15736 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15737 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15738 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015740wait_end : boolean
15741 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15742 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015743 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015744 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15745 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015746 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015747 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15748 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015750 Examples :
15751 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15752 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15753 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015755 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15756 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15757 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15758 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15759 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15760 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15761 tcp-request content reject
15762
15763
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157647.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015765--------------------------------------
15766
15767It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15768This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15769data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15770its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15771HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15772content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15773to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15774more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15775response are indexed.
15776
15777base : string
15778 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15779 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15780 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15781 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15782 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15783 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15784 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15785 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15786
15787 ACL derivatives :
15788 base : exact string match
15789 base_beg : prefix match
15790 base_dir : subdir match
15791 base_dom : domain match
15792 base_end : suffix match
15793 base_len : length match
15794 base_reg : regex match
15795 base_sub : substring match
15796
15797base32 : integer
15798 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15799 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15800 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015801 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15802 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15803 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015804
15805base32+src : binary
15806 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15807 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15808 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15809 per-URL counters.
15810
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015811capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15812 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15813 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15814 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15815
15816capture.req.method : string
15817 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15818 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15819 because it's allocated.
15820
15821capture.req.uri : string
15822 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15823 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15824 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15825 allocated.
15826
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015827capture.req.ver : string
15828 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15829 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15830 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15831
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015832capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15833 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15834 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15835 The first entry is an index of 0.
15836 See also: "capture response header"
15837
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015838capture.res.ver : string
15839 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15840 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15841 persistent flag.
15842
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015843req.body : binary
15844 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15845 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15846 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15847 the first chunk is analyzed.
15848
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015849req.body_param([<name>) : string
15850 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15851 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15852 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15853 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15854 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15855 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15856 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15857 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15858 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15859 given.
15860
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015861req.body_len : integer
15862 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15863 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15864 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15865 "option http-buffer-request".
15866
15867req.body_size : integer
15868 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15869 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15870 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15871 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15872 "option http-buffer-request".
15873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015874req.cook([<name>]) : string
15875cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15876 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15877 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15878 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15879 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15880 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15881 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15882 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15883 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15884
15885 ACL derivatives :
15886 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15887 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15888 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15889 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15890 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15891 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15892 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15893 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015895req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15896cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15897 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15898 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015900req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15901cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15902 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15903 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15904 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15905 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015907cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15908 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15909 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15910 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15911 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015912 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015913 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15914 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15915 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15916 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015918hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15919 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15920 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15921 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15922 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015923 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015925req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15926 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15927 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15928 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15929 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15930 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15931 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15932 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15933 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015935req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15936 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15937 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15938 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15939 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015941req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15942 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15943 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15944 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15945 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15946 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15947 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15948 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15949 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015950 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015951 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015952 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015954 ACL derivatives :
15955 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15956 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15957 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15958 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15959 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15960 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15961 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15962 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15963
15964req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15965hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15966 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15967 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15968 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15969 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15970 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15971 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15972 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15973 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15974 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15975
15976req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15977hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15978 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15979 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15980 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15981 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15982 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015983 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015984 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15985 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15986
15987req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15988hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15989 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15990 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15991 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15992 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15993 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15994 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15995 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15996
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010015997
15998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015999http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16000 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16001 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16002 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16003 basic auth is supported.
16004
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016005http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16006 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16007 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16008 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16009 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016010 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16011 basic auth is supported.
16012
16013 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016014 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16015 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16016 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16017 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016018
16019http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016020 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16021 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016022 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16023 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016025method : integer + string
16026 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16027 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16028 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16029 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16030 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16031 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16032 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016034 ACL derivatives :
16035 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016037 Example :
16038 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16039 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16040 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016042path : string
16043 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16044 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16045 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16046 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16047 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016048 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016049 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016051 ACL derivatives :
16052 path : exact string match
16053 path_beg : prefix match
16054 path_dir : subdir match
16055 path_dom : domain match
16056 path_end : suffix match
16057 path_len : length match
16058 path_reg : regex match
16059 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016060
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016061query : string
16062 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16063 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16064 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16065 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016066 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016067 which stops before the question mark.
16068
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016069req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16070 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16071 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16072 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16073 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016075req.ver : string
16076req_ver : string (deprecated)
16077 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16078 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16079 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016081 ACL derivatives :
16082 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016084res.comp : boolean
16085 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16086 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16087 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016089res.comp_algo : string
16090 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16091 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16092 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016094res.cook([<name>]) : string
16095scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16096 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16097 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16098 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016100 ACL derivatives :
16101 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016103res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16104scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16105 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16106 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16107 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016109res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16110scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16111 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16112 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16113 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016115res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16116 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16117 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16118 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16119 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16120 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16121 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16122 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16123 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16124 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016126res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16127 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16128 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16129 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16130 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16131 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016133res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16134shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16135 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16136 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16137 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16138 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16139 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16140 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16141 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16142 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016144 ACL derivatives :
16145 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16146 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16147 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16148 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16149 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16150 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16151 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16152 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16153
16154res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16155shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16156 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16157 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16158 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16159 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16160 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016162res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16163shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16164 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16165 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16166 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16167 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16168 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16169 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016170
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016171res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16172 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16173 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16174 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16175 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016177res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16178shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16179 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16180 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16181 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16182 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16183 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16184 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016186res.ver : string
16187resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16188 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16189 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016191 ACL derivatives :
16192 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016194set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16195 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16196 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016197 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016198 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016200 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16201 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016203status : integer
16204 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16205 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16206 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016207
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016208unique-id : string
16209 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16210 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16211 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16212 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16213 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16214 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016216url : string
16217 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16218 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16219 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16220 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16221 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16222 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16223 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016225 ACL derivatives :
16226 url : exact string match
16227 url_beg : prefix match
16228 url_dir : subdir match
16229 url_dom : domain match
16230 url_end : suffix match
16231 url_len : length match
16232 url_reg : regex match
16233 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016235url_ip : ip
16236 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16237 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16238 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16239 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16240 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16241 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16242 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016244url_port : integer
16245 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16246 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16247 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16248 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016249
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016250urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16251url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016252 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16253 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016254 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16255 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16256 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16257 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016258 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16259 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016260 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16261 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016263 ACL derivatives :
16264 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16265 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16266 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16267 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16268 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16269 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16270 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16271 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016272
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016274 Example :
16275 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16276 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16277 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16278 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016279
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016280urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016281 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16282 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16283 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016284
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016285url32 : integer
16286 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16287 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16288 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16289 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16290 is an unsigned integer.
16291
16292url32+src : binary
16293 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16294 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16295 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16296
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200162987.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016299---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016300
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016301Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16302every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016303order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016304
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016305ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16306---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016307FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016308HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016309HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16310HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016311HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16312HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16313HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16314HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16315LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016316METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016317METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016318METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16319METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16320METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16321METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016322METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016323METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016324RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016325REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016326TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016327WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16328---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016329
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163318. Logging
16332----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016333
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016334One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16335provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16336very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16337provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16338state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016339to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016340headers.
16341
16342In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16343about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16344send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16345
16346 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16347 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16348 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16349 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16350 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016351 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016352 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016353
16354The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16355allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16356as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16357while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16358real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16359delay.
16360
16361
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163628.1. Log levels
16363---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016364
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016365TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016366source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016367HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16368in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16369track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16370syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16371about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016372
16373
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163748.2. Log formats
16375----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016376
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016377HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016378and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16379slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16380options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016381
16382 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16383 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16384 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16385 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16386 extents.
16387
16388 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16389 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16390 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16391 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16392 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16393
16394 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16395 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16396 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16397 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16398 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16399
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016400 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16401 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16402 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16403 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16404
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016405 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16406
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016407Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16408specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16409field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16410servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16411always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16412identifier.
16413
16414Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16415 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16416 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16417 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16418 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16419
16420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164218.2.1. Default log format
16422-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016423
16424This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16425as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16426format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16427
16428 Example :
16429 listen www
16430 mode http
16431 log global
16432 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16433
16434 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16435 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16436 (www/HTTP)
16437
16438 Field Format Extract from the example above
16439 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16440 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16441 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16442 4 'to' to
16443 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16444 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16445
16446Detailed fields description :
16447 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16448 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16449 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16450 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16451 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16452 and processed the connection.
16453 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16454
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016455In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16456"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16457connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16458
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016459It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16460will eventually disappear.
16461
16462
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164638.2.2. TCP log format
16464---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016465
16466The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16467is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16468information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16469counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16470emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16471environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16472the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16473sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016474specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16475not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16476fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16477marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016478
16479 Example :
16480 frontend fnt
16481 mode tcp
16482 option tcplog
16483 log global
16484 default_backend bck
16485
16486 backend bck
16487 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16488
16489 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16490 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16491 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16492
16493 Field Format Extract from the example above
16494 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16495 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16496 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16497 4 frontend_name fnt
16498 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16499 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16500 7 bytes_read* 212
16501 8 termination_state --
16502 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16503 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16504
16505Detailed fields description :
16506 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016507 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16508 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16509 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016510 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016511 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016512 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016513
16514 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016515 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16516 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16517 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016518
16519 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16520 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16521 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016522 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16523 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16524 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16525 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016526
16527 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16528 and processed the connection.
16529
16530 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16531 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16532 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16533 applications.
16534
16535 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16536 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16537 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16538 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16539 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16540
16541 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16542 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16543 See "Timers" below for more details.
16544
16545 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16546 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16547 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16548 "Timers" below for more details.
16549
16550 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016551 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016552 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16553 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16554 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16555 details.
16556
16557 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16558 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16559 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16560 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16561 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16562
16563 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16564 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16565 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16566 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16567 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16568 for more details.
16569
16570 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016571 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016572 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16573 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16574 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016575 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016576
16577 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16578 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16579 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16580 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16581 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16582 caused by a denial of service attack.
16583
16584 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16585 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16586 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16587 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16588 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16589 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16590 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16591 denial of service attack.
16592
16593 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16594 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16595 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16596 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16597 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16598 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16599 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16600 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16601 be processed than on other servers.
16602
16603 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16604 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16605 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16606 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16607 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16608 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16609 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16610 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16611 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16612 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16613 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16614 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16615 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16616
16617 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16618 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16619 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16620 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16621 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16622 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016623 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016624 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16625
16626 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16627 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16628 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16629 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16630 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16631 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016632 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016633 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16634 occurs.
16635
16636
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166378.2.3. HTTP log format
16638----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016639
16640The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16641is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16642the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16643are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16644emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16645generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16646"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16647which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016648frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16649is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016650
16651Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16652slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16653with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16654
16655 Example :
16656 frontend http-in
16657 mode http
16658 option httplog
16659 log global
16660 default_backend bck
16661
16662 backend static
16663 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16664
16665 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16666 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16667 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016668 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016669
16670 Field Format Extract from the example above
16671 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16672 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016673 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016674 4 frontend_name http-in
16675 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016676 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016677 7 status_code 200
16678 8 bytes_read* 2750
16679 9 captured_request_cookie -
16680 10 captured_response_cookie -
16681 11 termination_state ----
16682 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16683 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16684 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16685 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16686 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016687
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016688Detailed fields description :
16689 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016690 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16691 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16692 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016693 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016694 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016695 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016696
16697 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016698 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16699 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16700 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016701
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016702 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16703 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016704
16705 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16706 and processed the connection.
16707
16708 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16709 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16710 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16711
16712 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16713 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16714 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16715 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16716 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16717 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16718
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016719 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16720 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16721 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16722 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16723 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16724 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016725 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16726 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016727
16728 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16729 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016730 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016731
16732 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16733 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016734 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16735 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016736
16737 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16738 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16739 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16740 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16741 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016742 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16743 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016744
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016745 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16746 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16747 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16748 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16749 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16750 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16751 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016752 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016753
16754 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16755 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16756 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16757
16758 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16759 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
16760 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
16761 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16762 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16763 overflowing.
16764
16765 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16766 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16767 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16768 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16769 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16770 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16771 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16772 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16773
16774 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16775 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16776 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16777 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16778 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16779 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16780 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16781 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16782
16783 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16784 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16785 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16786 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16787 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16788 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16789 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16790
16791 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016792 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016793 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16794 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16795 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016796 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016797 system.
16798
16799 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16800 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16801 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16802 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16803 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16804 caused by a denial of service attack.
16805
16806 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16807 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16808 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16809 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16810 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16811 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16812 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16813 denial of service attack.
16814
16815 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16816 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16817 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16818 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16819 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16820 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16821 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16822 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16823 processed than on other servers.
16824
16825 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16826 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16827 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16828 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16829 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16830 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16831 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16832 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16833 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16834 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16835 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16836 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16837 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16838
16839 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16840 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16841 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16842 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16843 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16844 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016845 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016846 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16847
16848 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16849 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16850 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16851 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16852 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16853 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016854 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016855 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16856 occurs.
16857
16858 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16859 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16860 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16861 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16862 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16863 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16864 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16865 cookies" below for more details.
16866
16867 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16868 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16869 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16870 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16871 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16872 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16873 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16874 and cookies" below for more details.
16875
16876 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16877 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16878 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16879 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16880 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16881 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16882 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16883 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16884
16885
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200168868.2.4. Custom log format
16887------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016888
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016889The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016890mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016891
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016892HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016893Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16894separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16895prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16896
16897Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16898variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016899("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016900
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016901If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016902as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016903less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16904the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16905
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016906Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016907In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016908in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016909
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016910Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16911'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16912https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16913such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16914
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016915Flags are :
16916 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016917 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016918 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16919 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016920
16921 Example:
16922
16923 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16924 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16925
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016926 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16927
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016928At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16929
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016930 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16931 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016932
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016933the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016934
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016935 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16936 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16937 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016938
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016939and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16940
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016941 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16942 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016943
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016944Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16945
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016946 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016947 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016948 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16949 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16950 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016951 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16952 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16953 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016954 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016955 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16956 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016957 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016958 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16959 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016960 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016961 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016962 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016963 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016964 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016965 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016966 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016967 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16968 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16969 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16970 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16971 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016972 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016973 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16974 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016975 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016976 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16977 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016978 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16979 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16980 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016981 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016982 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16983 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016984 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016985 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16986 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16987 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016988 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016989 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016990 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16991 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16992 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16993 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016994 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016995 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016996 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016997 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016998 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016999 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017000 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17001 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17002 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017003 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017004 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17005 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017006 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017007 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17008 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017009 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017010 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017011 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017012 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017013
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017014 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017015
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017016
170178.2.5. Error log format
17018-----------------------
17019
17020When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17021protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17022By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17023"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017024will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017025logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17026
17027The format looks like this :
17028
17029 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17030 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17031 Connection error during SSL handshake
17032
17033 Field Format Extract from the example above
17034 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17035 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17036 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17037 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17038 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17039
17040These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17041failures.
17042
17043
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170448.3. Advanced logging options
17045-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017046
17047Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17048just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17049options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17050for more information about their usage.
17051
17052
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170538.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17054------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017055
17056It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17057haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17058commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17059monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17060ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17061
17062 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17063 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17064 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17065 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17066
17067 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17068 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17069 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017070 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017071 such as other load-balancers.
17072
17073 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17074 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17075 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17076
17077
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170788.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17079----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017080
17081The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17082what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17083or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017084"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017085just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17086log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17087after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17088is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17089with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17090with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17091
17092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170938.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17094------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017095
17096Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17097for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17098"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17099retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17100raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17101a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17102file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17103you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17104"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17105
17106
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17108--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017109
17110Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17111multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17112them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17113"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17114logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17115error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17116and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17117too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17118useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17119alternative.
17120
17121
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171228.4. Timing events
17123------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017124
17125Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17126reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17127the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17128frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017129mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17130addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17131
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017132Timings events in HTTP mode:
17133
17134 first request 2nd request
17135 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17136 t tr t tr ...
17137 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17138 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17139 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17140 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17141 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17142
17143Timings events in TCP mode:
17144
17145 TCP session
17146 |<----------------->|
17147 t t
17148 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17149 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17150 |<------ Tt ------->|
17151
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017152 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017153 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017154 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17155 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17156 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017157 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017158 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17159 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17160 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17161 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017162
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017163 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17164 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17165 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017166 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17167 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17168 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17169 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17170 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17171 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017172
17173 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17174 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17175 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17176 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17177 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17178 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17179 request typed by hand during a test.
17180
17181 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17182 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017183 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017184 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17185 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17186 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17187 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017188
17189 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17190 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17191 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17192 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17193 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17194
17195 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17196 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17197 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17198 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17199 connection never established.
17200
17201 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17202 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17203 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17204 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17205 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17206 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17207 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17208 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17209 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17210 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17211 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17212
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017213 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17214 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17215 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17216 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17217 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17218 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17219
17220 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17221
17222 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17223 "Ta" can never be negative.
17224
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017225 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17226 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017227 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17228 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017229 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017230
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017231 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017232
17233 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017234 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17235 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017236
17237These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17238protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17239that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017240due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17241"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17242that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017243
17244Most common cases :
17245
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017246 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17247 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17248 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17249 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17250 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17251 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17252 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17253 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17254 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17255 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17256 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017257 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017258
17259 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17260 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17261 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17262 of ms on remote networks.
17263
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017264 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17265 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17266 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017267
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017268 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17269 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17270 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17271 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17272 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17273 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17274 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17275 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17276 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017277
17278Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17279
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017280 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017281 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017282 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017283
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017284 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017285 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17286 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17287
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017288 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017289 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17290 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17291 flags.
17292
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017293 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17294 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017295 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17296 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17297 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17298 the client connection was maintained open.
17299
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017300 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017301 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017302 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017303 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17304
17305
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173068.5. Session state at disconnection
17307-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017308
17309TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17310"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
173112-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17312each of which has a special meaning :
17313
17314 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17315 session to terminate :
17316
17317 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17318
17319 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17320 server explicitly refused it.
17321
17322 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17323 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17324 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17325 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017326 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017327
17328 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17329 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017330
17331 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17332 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17333 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17334 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17335 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17336
17337 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17338 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17339 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17340 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17341 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17342
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017343 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17344 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17345
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017346 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17347 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17348 backup connections when going up.
17349
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017350 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17351
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017352 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17353 send or receive data.
17354
17355 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17356 send or receive data.
17357
17358 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17359 with nothing left in the buffers.
17360
17361 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17362
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017363 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017364 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17365
17366 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17367 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17368 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17369 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17370 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17371
17372 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17373 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17374
17375 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17376 server (HTTP only).
17377
17378 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17379
17380 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17381 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17382 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17383
17384 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17385 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17386 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17387
17388 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17389
17390 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17391 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17392
17393 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17394 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17395 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17396
17397 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17398 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017399 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17400 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017401
17402 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17403 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17404 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17405 another server.
17406
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017407 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017408 server.
17409
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017410 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17411 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17412 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17413 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17414
17415 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17416 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17417 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17418 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17419
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017420 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17421 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17422 "use-server" rule).
17423
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017424 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17425
17426 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17427 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17428
17429 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17430
17431 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17432 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17433 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17434
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017435 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17436 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017437 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017438 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17439 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17440
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017441 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17442
17443 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17444 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17445
17446 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17447
17448 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17449
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017450The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17451was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017452helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17453starvation, attacks, etc...
17454
17455The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17456alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17457easier finding and understanding.
17458
17459 Flags Reason
17460
17461 -- Normal termination.
17462
17463 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17464 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17465 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17466 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17467
17468 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17469 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17470 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17471 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17472 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17473 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017474
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017475 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17476 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017477 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017478
17479 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17480 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17481 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17482
17483 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17484 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17485 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17486 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17487 the server takes too long to respond.
17488
17489 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17490 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17491 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17492 long a time to respond.
17493
17494 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17495 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17496 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17497 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017498 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17499 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017500
17501 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17502 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17503 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17504 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17505 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017506 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017507 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17508 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17509 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17510 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17511 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17512 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17513 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17514 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017515 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017516 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17517 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17518 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017519
17520 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17521 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017522 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17523 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17524 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17525 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017526
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017527 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17528 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17529
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017530 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017531 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17532 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017533 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017534 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17535 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17536
17537 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17538 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17539 503 or 504 here.
17540
17541 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17542 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17543 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17544 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17545 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17546
17547 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17548 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017549 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017550 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17551 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17552
17553 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17554 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17555 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17556 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17557 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17558 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17559 between haproxy and the server.
17560
17561 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17562 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17563 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17564 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17565 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17566 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17567 solution is to fix the application.
17568
17569 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17570 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17571 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17572 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17573 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17574 external attacks.
17575
17576 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17577 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017578 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017579 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17580 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17581
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017582 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17583 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17584 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017585 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017586 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017587
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017588 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17589 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17590 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17591 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017592 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17593 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17594 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17595 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17596 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017597
17598 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17599 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17600 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17601 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17602
17603 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17604 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17605 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17606 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17607
17608 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17609 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17610 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17611 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17612
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017613The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17614persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17615important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17616re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17617
17618 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17619
17620 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17621 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17622 set on a GET request.
17623
17624 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17625 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017626 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017627 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17628
17629 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17630 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17631 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17632
17633 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17634 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17635 already got a cookie.
17636
17637 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17638 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17639 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17640 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17641 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17642
17643 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17644 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17645 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17646
17647 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17648 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17649 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17650
17651 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17652 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17653
17654 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17655 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17656 then advertised in the response.
17657
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017658
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176598.6. Non-printable characters
17660-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017661
17662In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17663consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17664converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17665prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17666being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17667escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17668is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17669'}' when logging headers.
17670
17671Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17672issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17673containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17674
17675Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17676the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17677performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17678
17679
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176808.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17681---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017682
17683Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17684achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017685section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017686cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17687the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17688the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017689locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017690not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17691user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17692a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17693wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17694
17695 Examples :
17696 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17697 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17698
17699 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17700 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17701
17702
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17704---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017705
17706Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17707proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17708the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17709server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17710
17711Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17712response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017713section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017714
17715It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017716time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17717appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017718are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17719and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17720follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17721request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17722in the logs.
17723
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017724As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17725frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17726an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17727
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017728 Example :
17729 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17730 listen proxy-out
17731 mode http
17732 option httplog
17733 option logasap
17734 log global
17735 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17736
17737 # log the name of the virtual server
17738 capture request header Host len 20
17739
17740 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17741 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17742
17743 # log the beginning of the referrer
17744 capture request header Referer len 20
17745
17746 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17747 capture response header Server len 20
17748
17749 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17750 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17751
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017752 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017753 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17754
17755 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17756 capture response header Via len 20
17757
17758 # log the URL location during a redirection
17759 capture response header Location len 20
17760
17761 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17762 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17763 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17764 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17765 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17766
17767 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17768 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17769 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17770 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017771 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017772
17773 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17774 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17775 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17776 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17777 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017778 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017779
17780
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177818.9. Examples of logs
17782---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017783
17784These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17785them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17786reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17787
17788 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17789 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17790 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17791
17792 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17793 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17794
17795 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17796 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17797 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17798
17799 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17800 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17801
17802 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17803 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17804 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17805
17806 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017807 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017808 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17809 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17810
17811 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17812 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17813 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17814
17815 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
17816 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020017817 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017818 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
17819 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
17820 to return the 502 and not the server.
17821
17822 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017823 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017824
17825 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17826 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17827 Nothing was sent to any server.
17828
17829 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17830 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17831
17832 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17833 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017834 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017835 send a 408 return code to the client.
17836
17837 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17838 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17839
17840 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17841 5 seconds ("c----").
17842
17843 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17844 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017845 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017846
17847 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017848 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017849 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17850 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17851 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17852 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17853 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017854
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017855
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200178569. Supported filters
17857--------------------
17858
17859Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17860accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17861unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17862
17863See also : "filter"
17864
178659.1. Trace
17866----------
17867
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017868filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017869
17870 Arguments:
17871 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17872 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17873
17874 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17875 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17876 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17877 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17878
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017879 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017880 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17881 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17882 amount of the parsed data.
17883
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017884 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017885
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017886This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17887callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17888information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17889filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17890
17891Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17892tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17893a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17894
17895
178969.2. HTTP compression
17897---------------------
17898
17899filter compression
17900
17901The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17902keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017903when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
17904it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
17905response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
17906line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
17907cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
17908the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017909
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017910See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017911
17912
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200179139.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17914--------------------------------------------
17915
17916filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17917
17918 Arguments :
17919
17920 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17921 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17922 parsed.
17923
17924 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17925 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17926 part must be placed in its own scope.
17927
17928The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17929external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017930streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017931exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17932also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17933
17934SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17935the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17936
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017937For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017938"doc/SPOE.txt".
17939
17940Important note:
17941 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17942 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17943
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100179449.4. Cache
17945----------
17946
17947filter cache <name>
17948
17949 Arguments :
17950
17951 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
17952
17953The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
17954"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
17955cache. By default the correpsonding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017956other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
17957the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
17958mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
17959filter other than the compression is used for the same
17960listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17961order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017962
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017963See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017964
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001796510. Cache
17966---------
17967
17968HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17969(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17970RAM.
17971
17972The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017973this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017974
17975If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17976independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17977when we try to allocate a new one.
17978
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017979The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017980
17981It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17982"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17983for more details.
17984
17985When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17986replaced by "<CACHE>".
17987
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001798810.1. Limitation
17989----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017990
17991The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17992
17993- If the response is not a 200
17994- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017995- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017996- If the response is not cacheable
17997
17998- If the request is not a GET
17999- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018000- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018001
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018002Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18003filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18004can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18005example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18006"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018007
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001800810.2. Setup
18009-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018010
18011To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18012the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18013
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001801410.2.1. Cache section
18015---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018016
18017cache <name>
18018 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18019 size of cache is mandatory.
18020
18021total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018022 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018023 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018024
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018025max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018026 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18027 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18028 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018029
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018030max-age <seconds>
18031 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18032 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18033 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18034 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18035 default.
18036
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001803710.2.2. Proxy section
18038---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018039
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018040http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018041 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18042 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18043 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18044 after this one.
18045
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018046http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018047 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18048 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18049 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18050 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18051
18052
18053Example:
18054
18055 backend bck1
18056 mode http
18057
18058 http-request cache-use foobar
18059 http-response cache-store foobar
18060 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18061
18062 cache foobar
18063 total-max-size 4
18064 max-age 240
18065
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018066/*
18067 * Local variables:
18068 * fill-column: 79
18069 * End:
18070 */